blob: b7c3b7e8d98e8b340bb4fdebd7dfbe600189583f [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau33205c22020-07-07 16:35:28 +02005 version 2.3
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau3a00c912020-07-07 16:33:14 +02007 2020/07/07
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020057
584. Proxies
594.1. Proxy keywords matrix
604.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
61
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100625. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200635.1. Bind options
645.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200655.3. Server DNS resolution
665.3.1. Global overview
675.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020068
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100696. Cache
706.1. Limitation
716.2. Setup
726.2.1. Cache section
736.2.2. Proxy section
74
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200757. Using ACLs and fetching samples
767.1. ACL basics
777.1.1. Matching booleans
787.1.2. Matching integers
797.1.3. Matching strings
807.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
817.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
827.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
837.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
847.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200857.3.1. Converters
867.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
877.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
887.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
897.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
907.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200917.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200927.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093
948. Logging
958.1. Log levels
968.2. Log formats
978.2.1. Default log format
988.2.2. TCP log format
998.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001008.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001018.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001028.3. Advanced logging options
1038.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1048.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1058.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1068.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1078.4. Timing events
1088.5. Session state at disconnection
1098.6. Non-printable characters
1108.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1118.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1128.9. Examples of logs
113
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001149. Supported filters
1159.1. Trace
1169.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001179.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001189.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001199.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200120
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012110. FastCGI applications
12210.1. Setup
12310.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12410.1.2. Proxy section
12510.1.3. Example
12610.2. Default parameters
12710.3. Limitations
128
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129
1301. Quick reminder about HTTP
131----------------------------
132
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
135on almost anything found in the contents.
136
137However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
138formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
139correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
140
141
1421.1. The HTTP transaction model
143-------------------------------
144
145The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100146to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100147from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
148connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149will involve a new connection :
150
151 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
152
153In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
154establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
155by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
156length.
157
158Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
159to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
160however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
161response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
162header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
167power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
168but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200169a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100171Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
173second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
174page :
175
176 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
177
178This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
179latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
180correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
181the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100182server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100184The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
185time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
186are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
187parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
188carry the stream identifier.
189
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
191connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
192leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100193start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
194processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
195waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200196
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200197HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
199 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100200 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100201 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200202 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100203
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100204
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205
2061.2. HTTP request
207-----------------
208
209First, let's consider this HTTP request :
210
211 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100212 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
214 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
215 3 User-agent: my small browser
216 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
217 5 Accept: image/png
218
219
2201.2.1. The Request line
221-----------------------
222
223Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
224
225 - a METHOD : GET
226 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
227 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
228
229All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
230which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
231followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
232is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
233desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
234the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
235
236The URI itself can have several forms :
237
238 - A "relative URI" :
239
240 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241
242 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
243 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
244
245 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
246
247 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
248
249 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
250 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
251 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
252 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
253 must accept this form too.
254
255 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
256 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
257 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100258
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200259 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
260 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
261 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
262 other protocols too.
263
264In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
265mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
266on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
267It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
268specific to the language, framework or application in use.
269
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100270HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100271assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100272
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200273
2741.2.2. The request headers
275--------------------------
276
277The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
278beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
279an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
280Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
281values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
282encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
283the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
284define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
285
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100286Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100288"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200289as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
290normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
291representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
292HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200293
294The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
295that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
296is one valid form of empty line.
297
298Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
299headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
300about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
301application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
302
303Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000304 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200305 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
306 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
307 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
308
309
3101.3. HTTP response
311------------------
312
313An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
314messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
315
316 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100317 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200318 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
319 2 Content-length: 350
320 3 Content-Type: text/html
321
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200322As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
323codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
324response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100325continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
326the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
327following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
328sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
329(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
330correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
331such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
332state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
333over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
334if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
335information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200336
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200337
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003381.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200339------------------------
340
341Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
342
343 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
344 - a status code : 200
345 - a reason : OK
346
347The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100348 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
349 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
350 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
351 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
352 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200353
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000354Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100355"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200356found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
357messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
358or "Authentication Required".
359
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100360HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361
362 Code When / reason
363 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
364 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
365 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
366 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100367 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
368 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200369 400 for an invalid or too large request
370 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
371 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200372 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100373 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200374 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100375 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
376 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200377 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
378 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
379 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200380 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
382 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
383 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
384
385The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3864.2).
387
388
3891.3.2. The response headers
390---------------------------
391
392Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
393the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
394details.
395
396
3972. Configuring HAProxy
398----------------------
399
4002.1. Configuration file format
401------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200402
403HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
404
405 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
406 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
407 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
408 "frontend" and "backend".
409
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100410The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
411referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100413
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200414
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004152.2. Quoting and escaping
416-------------------------
417
418HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
419many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
420with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
421single quotes.
422
423If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
424them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
425escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
426
427Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
428
429 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
430 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
431 \\ to use a backslash
432 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
433 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
434
435Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
436the interpretation of:
437
438 space as a parameter separator
439 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
440 # hash as a comment start
441
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200442Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
443-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
444backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
445
446Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200447quoting.
448
449Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
450nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
451
452Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
453equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
454
455 Example:
456 # those are equivalents:
457 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
458 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
459 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
460 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
461 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
462
463 # those are equivalents:
464 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
465 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
466 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
467 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
468
469
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004702.3. Environment variables
471--------------------------
472
473HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
474interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
475configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
476optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
477shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
478underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
479
480 Example:
481
482 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
483
484 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
485
486 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
487
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200488Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
489file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200490
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200491* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
492 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
493
494* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
495 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
496 directory.
497
498* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
499
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500500* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200501 processes, separated by semicolons.
502
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500503* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200504 CLI, separated by semicolons.
505
506See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200507
5082.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200509----------------
510
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100511Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100512values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
513otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
514numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
515for every keyword. Supported units are :
516
517 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
518 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
519 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
520 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
521 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
522 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
523
524
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005252.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200526-------------
527
528 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
529 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
530 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
531 global
532 daemon
533 maxconn 256
534
535 defaults
536 mode http
537 timeout connect 5000ms
538 timeout client 50000ms
539 timeout server 50000ms
540
541 frontend http-in
542 bind *:80
543 default_backend servers
544
545 backend servers
546 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
547
548
549 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
550 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
551 global
552 daemon
553 maxconn 256
554
555 defaults
556 mode http
557 timeout connect 5000ms
558 timeout client 50000ms
559 timeout server 50000ms
560
561 listen http-in
562 bind *:80
563 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
564
565
566Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
567
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100568 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200569
570
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005713. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200572--------------------
573
574Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
575are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
576of them have command-line equivalents.
577
578The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
579
580 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200581 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200582 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200583 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200584 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200585 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200586 - description
587 - deviceatlas-json-file
588 - deviceatlas-log-level
589 - deviceatlas-separator
590 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900591 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200592 - gid
593 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100594 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200595 - h1-case-adjust
596 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100597 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100598 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100599 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200600 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200601 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200602 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100603 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200604 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100605 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200606 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200607 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200608 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200609 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200610 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200611 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100612 - presetenv
613 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200614 - uid
615 - ulimit-n
616 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200617 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100618 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200619 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200620 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200621 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200622 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200623 - ssl-default-bind-options
624 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200625 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200626 - ssl-default-server-options
627 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100628 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200629 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100630 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100631 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100632 - 51degrees-data-file
633 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200634 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200635 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200636 - wurfl-data-file
637 - wurfl-information-list
638 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200639 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100640 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100641
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200642 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100643 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200644 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200645 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200646 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100647 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100648 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100649 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200650 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200651 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200652 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200653 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200654 - noepoll
655 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000656 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200657 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100658 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300659 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000660 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100661 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200662 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200663 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200664 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000665 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000666 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200667 - tune.buffers.limit
668 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200669 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200670 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100671 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +0200672 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200673 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200674 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200675 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100676 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200677 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200678 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +0200679 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100680 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100681 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100682 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100683 - tune.lua.session-timeout
684 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200685 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100686 - tune.maxaccept
687 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200688 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200689 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200690 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +0200691 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
692 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100693 - tune.rcvbuf.client
694 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100695 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200696 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +0200697 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100698 - tune.sndbuf.client
699 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100700 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +0200701 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100702 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200703 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100704 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200705 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200706 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100707 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200708 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100709 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200710 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
711 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
712 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100713 - tune.zlib.memlevel
714 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100715
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200716 * Debugging
717 - debug
718 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200719 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200720
721
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007223.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200723------------------------------------
724
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200725ca-base <dir>
726 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100727 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
728 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
729 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200730
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200731chroot <jail dir>
732 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
733 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
734 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
735 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
736 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100737 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100738
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100739cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
740 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
741 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
742 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
743 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
744 set. These sets have the format
745
746 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
747
748 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100749 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100750 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
751 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100752 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
753 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100754 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100755 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100756 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100757 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100758 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
759 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
760 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
761 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100762
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100763 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
764 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
765 on the machine's word size.
766
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100767 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100768 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
769 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
770 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
771 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
772 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
773 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100774
775 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100776 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
777
778 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
779 # first 4 CPUs
780
781 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
782 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
783 # word size.
784
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100785 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100786 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100787 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
788 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
789 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
790
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100791 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
792 # and so on.
793 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
794 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
795 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
796
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100797 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100798 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
799 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
800 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
801
802 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
803 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
804 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
805
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100806 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
807 # and a thread range.
808 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
809 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
810 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
811
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200812crt-base <dir>
813 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100814 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
815 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200816
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200817daemon
818 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
819 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100820 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
821 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200822
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200823deviceatlas-json-file <path>
824 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100825 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200826
827deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100828 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200829 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
830
831deviceatlas-separator <char>
832 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
833 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
834
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100835deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200836 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
837 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
838 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100839
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900840external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100841 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
842 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100843 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
844 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
845 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
846 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
847 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900848
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200849gid <number>
850 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
851 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
852 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100853 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
854 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200855 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100856
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100857group <group name>
858 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
859 See also "gid" and "user".
860
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100861hard-stop-after <time>
862 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
863
864 Arguments :
865 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
866 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
867 SIGUSR1 signal.
868
869 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
870 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
871 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
872
873 Example:
874 global
875 hard-stop-after 30s
876
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200877h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
878 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
879 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
880 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
881 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500882 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200883 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
884 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
885 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
886 specified in a proxy.
887
888 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
889 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
890 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
891 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
892 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
893 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
894 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
895
896 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
897 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
898 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
899 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
900 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
901
902 Example:
903 global
904 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
905
906 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
907 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
908
909h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
910 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
911 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
912 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
913 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
914 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
915 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
916 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
917 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
918
919 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
920 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
921 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
922
923 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
924 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
925
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100926insecure-fork-wanted
927 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
928 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
929 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
930 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
931 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
932 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
933 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
934 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
935 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
936 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
937 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
938 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
939 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
940 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
941 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
942 disable it.
943
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100944insecure-setuid-wanted
945 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
946 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
947 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
948 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
949 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
950 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
951 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
952 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
953 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
954 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
955 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
956 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
957 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
958 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
959
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100960issuers-chain-path <dir>
961 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
962 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
963 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
964 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
965 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
966 "issuers-chain-path".
967 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
968 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
969 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
970 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
971 will share the chain in memory.
972
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200973localpeer <name>
974 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
975 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
976 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
977 the configuration parsing.
978
979 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
980 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
981
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200982log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
983 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100984 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100985 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100986 configured with "log global".
987
988 <address> can be one of:
989
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100990 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100991 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
992 port).
993
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100994 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
995 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
996 port).
997
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100998 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100999 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1000 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001001 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001002
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001003 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1004 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1005 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1006 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1007 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1008 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1009 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1010 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1011 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1012 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1013 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1014 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1015 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1016 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001017 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1018 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001019
1020 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1021 "fd@2", see above.
1022
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001023 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1024 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1025 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1026 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1027 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1028
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001029 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1030 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001031
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001032 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1033 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1034 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1035 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1036 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1037 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1038 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1039 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1040 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1041 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001042 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1043 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001044
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001045 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1046 one of the following :
1047
1048 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1049 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1050
1051 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1052 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1053
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001054 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1055 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1056 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1057 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1058 logger consumes.
1059
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001060 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1061 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1062 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1063 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1064
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001065 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1066 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1067 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1068 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1069 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1070
1071 <sample_size>
1072 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1073 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1074 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1075 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1076 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1077
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001078 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001079
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001080 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1081 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1082 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1083
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001084 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1085 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1086 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1087 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001088
1089 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001090 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1091 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1092 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1093 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1094 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1095 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001096
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001097 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001098
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001099log-send-hostname [<string>]
1100 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1101 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1102 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1103 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1104 the logs.
1105
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001106log-tag <string>
1107 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1108 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1109 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001110 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001111
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001112lua-load <file>
1113 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1114 used multiple times.
1115
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001116lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1117 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1118 variable.
1119 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1120 to "path".
1121
1122 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1123 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1124 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1125 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1126 will be checked earlier.
1127
1128 As an example by specifying the following path:
1129
1130 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1131 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1132
1133 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1134 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1135 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1136 paths if that does not exist either.
1137
1138 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1139 documentation.
1140
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001141master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001142 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1143 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1144 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001145 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001146 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1147 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001148 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1149 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1150 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1151 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1152 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001153
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001154 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001155
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001156mworker-max-reloads <number>
1157 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001158 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001159 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1160 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1161 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1162
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001163nbproc <number>
1164 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1165 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1166 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001167 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1168 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001169 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1170 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001171
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001172nbthread <number>
1173 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001174 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1175 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1176 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1177 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1178 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001179 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1180 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1181 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1182 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1183 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1184 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1185 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001186
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001187pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001188 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001189 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1190 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1191
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001192pp2-never-send-local
1193 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1194 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1195 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1196 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1197 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1198 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1199 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1200 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1201 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1202 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1203 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1204
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001205presetenv <name> <value>
1206 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1207 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1208 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1209 and "unsetenv".
1210
1211resetenv [<name> ...]
1212 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1213 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1214 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1215 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1216 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1217 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1218 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1219 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1220
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001221stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001222 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1223 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1224 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1225 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1226 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1227 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001228 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001229 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1230 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1231 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1232 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001233
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001234server-state-base <directory>
1235 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001236 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1237 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001238
1239server-state-file <file>
1240 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1241 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1242 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1243 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1244 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1245 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1246 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1247 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001248 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1249 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001250
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001251setenv <name> <value>
1252 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1253 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1254 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1255 and "unsetenv".
1256
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001257set-dumpable
1258 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001259 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1260 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1261 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1262 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1263 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1264 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1265 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1266 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1267 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1268 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1269 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1270 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1271 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1272 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1273 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1274 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1275 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001276
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001277ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1278 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1279 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001280 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001281 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001282 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1283 information and recommendations see e.g.
1284 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1285 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1286 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1287 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001288
1289ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1290 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1291 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1292 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1293 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1294 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001295 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1296 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1297 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001298 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001299
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001300ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1301 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1302 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1303 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1304 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1305 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1306
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001307ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1308 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1309 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1310 keyword to see available options.
1311
1312 Example:
1313 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001314 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001315
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001316ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1317 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1318 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001319 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001320 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001321 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1322 information and recommendations see e.g.
1323 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1324 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1325 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1326 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1327 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001328
1329ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1330 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1331 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1332 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1333 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1334 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001335 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1336 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1337 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1338 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001339
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001340ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1341 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1342 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1343 keyword to see available options.
1344
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001345ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1346 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1347 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1348 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001349 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001350 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001351 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1352 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1353 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1354 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001355 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1356 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1357 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1358
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001359ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001360 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
1361 the loading of the SSL certificates.
1362
1363 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1364 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1365 optimize the startup time.
1366
1367 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1368 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1369 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1370
1371 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001372 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001373
1374 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
1375 will try to load a certificate bundle. This is done by looking for
1376 <basename>.rsa, .ecdsa and .dsa. In the case of directories, HAProxy will
1377 try to gather the files with the same basename in a multi-certificate bundle.
1378 The bundles were introduced with OpenSSL 1.0.2 and were the only way back
1379 then to load an ECDSA certificate and a RSA one, with the same SNI. Since
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001380 OpenSSL 1.1.1 it is not recommended anymore, you can specify both the ECDSA
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001381 and the RSA file on the bind line.
1382
1383 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1384
1385 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1386
1387 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1388 not provided in the PEM file.
1389
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001390 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1391 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1392
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001393 The default behavior is "all".
1394
1395 Example:
1396 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1397 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1398 ssl-load-extra-files none
1399
1400 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1401
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001402ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1403 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1404 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1405 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1406
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001407ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001408 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001409 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1410 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1411 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1412 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1413 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1414 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
1415 bits does not need it.
1416
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001417stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1418 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1419 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1420 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001421 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001422 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001423
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001424 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1425 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1426 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001427
1428stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1429 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1430 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001431 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001432
1433stats maxconn <connections>
1434 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1435 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1436
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001437uid <number>
1438 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1439 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1440 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1441 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1442
1443ulimit-n <number>
1444 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1445 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1446 option.
1447
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001448unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1449 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1450
1451 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1452 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1453 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1454 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1455 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1456 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1457 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1458 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1459 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1460 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1461
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001462unsetenv [<name> ...]
1463 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1464 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1465 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1466 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1467 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1468 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1469 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1470
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001471user <user name>
1472 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1473 See also "uid" and "group".
1474
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001475node <name>
1476 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1477
1478 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1479 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1480 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1481 traffic.
1482
1483description <text>
1484 Add a text that describes the instance.
1485
1486 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1487 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1488 "<" and ">" characters.
1489
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100149051degrees-data-file <file path>
1491 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001492 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001493
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001494 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001495 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1496
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000149751degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001498 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1499 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1500 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1501
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001502 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001503 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1504
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200150551degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001506 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1507 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1508
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001509 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1510 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1511
151251degrees-cache-size <number>
1513 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1514 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1515 By default, this cache is disabled.
1516
1517 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001518 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1519
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001520wurfl-data-file <file path>
1521 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1522 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1523
1524 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1525 with USE_WURFL=1.
1526
1527wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1528 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1529 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1530 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1531
1532 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1533
1534 Valid WURFL properties are:
1535 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1536
1537 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1538 device.
1539
1540 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1541 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1542
1543 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1544 particular web request.
1545
1546 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1547 used Libwurfl API version.
1548
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001549 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1550 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1551
1552 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1553 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1554
1555 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1556
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001557 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1558 with USE_WURFL=1.
1559
1560wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1561 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1562 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1563
1564 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1565 with USE_WURFL=1.
1566
1567wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1568 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1569 thus before the chroot.
1570
1571 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1572 with USE_WURFL=1.
1573
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001574wurfl-cache-size <size>
1575 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1576 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001577 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001578 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001579
1580 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1581 with USE_WURFL=1.
1582
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001583strict-limits
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01001584 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy tries to set the
1585 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
1586 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
1587 haproxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
1588 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001589
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015903.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001591-----------------------
1592
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001593busy-polling
1594 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1595 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1596 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1597 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1598 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1599 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1600 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1601 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1602 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1603 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1604 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1605 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1606 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1607 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1608 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1609 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1610 "poll" pollers.
1611
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001612 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1613 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1614 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1615
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001616max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1617 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1618 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1619 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1620 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1621 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1622 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1623 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1624 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1625
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001626maxconn <number>
1627 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1628 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1629 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001630 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1631 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1632 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1633 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001634 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1635 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1636 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1637 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1638 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1639 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001640
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001641maxconnrate <number>
1642 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1643 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1644 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1645 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1646 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1647 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1648 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1649 fairness.
1650
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001651maxcomprate <number>
1652 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001653 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001654 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1655 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1656 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001657 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001658 default value.
1659
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001660maxcompcpuusage <number>
1661 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1662 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1663 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1664 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1665 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1666 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1667 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1668 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1669
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001670maxpipes <number>
1671 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1672 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1673 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1674 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1675 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1676 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1677
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001678maxsessrate <number>
1679 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1680 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1681 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1682 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1683 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1684 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1685 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1686 fairness.
1687
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001688maxsslconn <number>
1689 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1690 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1691 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1692 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1693 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1694 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1695 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001696 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1697 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1698 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1699 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1700 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1701 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1702 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001703
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001704maxsslrate <number>
1705 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1706 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1707 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1708 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1709 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1710 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1711 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1712 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1713 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1714 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1715
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001716maxzlibmem <number>
1717 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1718 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1719 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001720 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1721 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1722 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1723
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001724noepoll
1725 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1726 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001727 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001728
1729nokqueue
1730 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1731 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1732 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1733
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001734noevports
1735 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1736 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1737 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1738 also "nopoll".
1739
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001740nopoll
1741 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1742 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001743 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001744 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1745 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001746
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001747nosplice
1748 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001749 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001750 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001751 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001752 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1753 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1754 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1755 "option splice-response".
1756
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001757nogetaddrinfo
1758 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1759 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1760
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001761noreuseport
1762 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1763 command line argument "-dR".
1764
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001765profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1766 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1767 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1768 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1769 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001770 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001771 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1772 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1773 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1774 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1775
1776 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1777 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1778 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1779 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1780 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001781 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1782 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1783 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1784 CLI.
1785
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001786spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001787 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1788 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1789 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1790 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1791 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1792 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001793
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001794ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001795 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001796 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001797 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1798 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1799 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1800 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1801 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001802 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1803 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001804 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1805 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1806 openssl configuration file uses:
1807 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1808
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001809ssl-mode-async
1810 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001811 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001812 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1813 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1814 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001815 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001816 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001817
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001818tune.buffers.limit <number>
1819 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1820 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1821 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1822 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1823 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001824 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001825 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1826 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1827 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1828 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1829 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1830 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1831 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1832 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1833 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1834
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001835tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1836 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1837 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1838 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1839 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1840
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001841tune.bufsize <number>
1842 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1843 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1844 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1845 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1846 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1847 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1848 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001849 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1850 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1851 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001852 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001853 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1854 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1855 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001856
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001857tune.chksize <number>
1858 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1859 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1860 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1861 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1862 checks whenever possible.
1863
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001864tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1865 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1866 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1867 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1868 this value. The default value is 1.
1869
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001870tune.fail-alloc
1871 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1872 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1873 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1874 gracefully.
1875
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001876tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
1877 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
1878 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
1879 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
1880 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
1881 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
1882
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001883tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1884 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1885 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1886 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1887 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1888 change it.
1889
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001890tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1891 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001892 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1893 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001894 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1895 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1896 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1897 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1898 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1899
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001900tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1901 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1902 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1903 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1904 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1905 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1906 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1907 recommended not to change this value.
1908
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001909tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1910 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1911 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1912 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1913 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1914 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1915 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1916 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1917
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001918tune.http.cookielen <number>
1919 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1920 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1921 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1922 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1923 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1924 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1925 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1926 to change this value.
1927
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001928tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001929 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1930 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001931 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001932 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001933 configuration directives too.
1934 The default value is 1024.
1935
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001936tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1937 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1938 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1939 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1940 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1941 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1942 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001943 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1944 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1945 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001946
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001947tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
1948 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
1949 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
1950 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
1951 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
1952 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
1953 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
1954 this option to "off". The default is on.
1955
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001956tune.idletimer <timeout>
1957 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1958 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1959 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1960 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1961 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1962 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001963 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001964 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001965 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1966
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001967tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1968 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1969 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1970 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1971 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1972 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1973 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1974 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1975 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1976 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1977
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001978tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1979 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001980 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001981 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1982 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001983 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001984 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1985 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1986
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001987tune.lua.maxmem
1988 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1989 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1990 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1991 memory.
1992
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001993tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1994 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001995 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1996 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001997 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001998
1999tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2000 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2001 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2002 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2003 check servers.
2004
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002005tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2006 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2007 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2008 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002009 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002010
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002011tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002012 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2013 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
2014 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
2015 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
2016 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
2017 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
2018 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
2019 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
2020 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
2021 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002022
2023tune.maxpollevents <number>
2024 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2025 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2026 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2027 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2028 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2029
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002030tune.maxrewrite <number>
2031 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2032 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2033 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2034 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2035 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2036 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2037 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2038 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2039 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2040 bufsize.
2041
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002042tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2043 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2044 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2045 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2046 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2047 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2048 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2049 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2050 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2051 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002052 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2053 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002054 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2055 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2056 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2057 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2058 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2059 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2060 setting this parameter to 0.
2061
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002062tune.pipesize <number>
2063 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2064 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2065 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2066 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2067 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2068 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2069
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002070tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2071 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2072 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2073 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2074 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2075 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2076 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002077 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002078
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002079tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2080 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2081 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2082 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2083 default is 20.
2084
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002085tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2086tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2087 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2088 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2089 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002090 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002091 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002092 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2093 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2094
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002095tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002096 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002097 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2098 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2099 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2100 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2101
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002102tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002103 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002104 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002105 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead. When
2106 experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2107 tune.sched.low-latency to limit the maximum latency to the lowest possible.
2108
2109tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2110 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2111 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2112 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2113 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2114 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2115 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2116 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2117 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2118 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002119
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002120tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2121tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2122 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2123 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2124 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002125 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002126 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002127 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2128 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2129 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2130 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2131 notifying haproxy again.
2132
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002133tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002134 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2135 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2136 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002137 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002138 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002139 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002140 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2141 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2142 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002143 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2144 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002145
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002146tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002147 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002148 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2149 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2150 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2151 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2152 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2153
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002154tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2155 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2156 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2157 performances. This is disabled by default.
2158
2159 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2160 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2161
2162 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2163
2164 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2165
2166 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2167
2168 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2169 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2170 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2171
2172 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2173 converted.
2174
2175 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2176 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2177 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2178 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2179 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2180 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2181 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002182 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2183 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002184
2185 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2186
2187 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2188 only need this line:
2189
2190 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2191
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002192tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2193 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002194 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002195 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2196 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2197 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2198 being used for too long.
2199
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002200tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2201 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2202 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2203 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2204 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2205 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2206 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2207 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2208 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2209 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2210 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002211 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002212 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002213
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002214tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2215 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2216 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2217 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2218 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002219 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002220 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2221 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002222 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2223 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002224
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002225tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2226 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2227 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2228 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2229 1000 entries.
2230
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002231tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2232 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2233 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2234 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2235
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002236tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002237tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002238tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2239tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2240tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002241 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2242 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2243 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2244 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2245 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2246 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2247 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2248 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002249
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002250 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2251 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2252 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2253 all available space is consumed.
2254 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2255 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2256 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002257
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002258tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2259 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002260 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002261 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002262 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002263 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2264
2265tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2266 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2267 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002268 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2269 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002270
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022713.3. Debugging
2272--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002273
Willy Tarreau1b857852020-02-25 11:27:22 +01002274debug (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002275 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2276 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2277 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2278 system startup.
2279
2280quiet
2281 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2282 line argument "-q".
2283
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002284zero-warning
2285 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2286 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2287 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2288 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2289 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2290 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2291
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002292
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010022933.4. Userlists
2294--------------
2295It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2296http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2297it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2298
2299userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002300 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002301 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2302
2303group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002304 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002305 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2306 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2307
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002308user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2309 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002310 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2311 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002312 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2313 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2314 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2315 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002316
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002317 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2318 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2319 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2320 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2321 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2322 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2323 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2324 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2325 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002326
2327 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002328 userlist L1
2329 group G1 users tiger,scott
2330 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002331
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002332 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2333 user scott insecure-password elgato
2334 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002335
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002336 userlist L2
2337 group G1
2338 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002339
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002340 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2341 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2342 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002343
2344 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002345
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002346
23473.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002348----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002349It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2350several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2351instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2352values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2353automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2354In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2355using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2356tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2357reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2358Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2359that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2360each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002361
2362peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002363 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002364 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2365
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002366bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2367 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2368 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2369
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002370disabled
2371 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2372 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2373 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2374
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002375default-bind [param*]
2376 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2377
2378default-server [param*]
2379 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2380
2381 Arguments:
2382 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2383 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2384 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2385 details.
2386
2387
2388 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2389
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002390enable
2391 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2392
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002393log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2394 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2395 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2396 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2397 more details.
2398
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002399peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002400 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2401 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002402 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2403 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2404 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2405 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2406 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002407
2408 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2409 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2410
2411 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002412 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2413 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2414 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002415
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002416 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2417 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002418
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002419 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2420 "server" keyword explanation below).
2421
2422server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002423 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002424 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2425 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2426 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2427 of this "peers" section).
2428 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2429
2430
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002431 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002432 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002433 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002434 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2435 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2436 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002437
2438 backend mybackend
2439 mode tcp
2440 balance roundrobin
2441 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2442 stick on src
2443
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002444 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2445 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002446
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002447 Example:
2448 peers mypeers
2449 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2450 default-server ssl verify none
2451 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2452 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002453
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002454
2455table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2456 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2457
2458 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2459 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002460 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002461 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2462 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2463 "stick-table" keyword).
2464
2465 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2466 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2467 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2468 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2469 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2470 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2471 of the stick-table name as follows:
2472
2473 peers mypeers
2474 peer A ...
2475 peer B ...
2476 table t1 ...
2477
2478 frontend fe1
2479 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2480
2481 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2482 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2483
2484 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2485 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2486 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2487 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2488 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2489 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2490 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2491
2492 peers mypeers
2493 peer A ...
2494 peer B ...
2495 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2496
2497 backend t1
2498 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2499
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002500 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002501 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2502 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2503
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090025043.6. Mailers
2505------------
2506It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2507If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2508in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2509
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002510mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002511 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2512 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2513
2514mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2515 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2516
2517 Example:
2518 mailers mymailers
2519 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2520 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2521
2522 backend mybackend
2523 mode tcp
2524 balance roundrobin
2525
2526 email-alert mailers mymailers
2527 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2528 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2529
2530 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2531 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2532
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002533timeout mail <time>
2534 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2535 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2536 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2537 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2538
2539 Example:
2540 mailers mymailers
2541 timeout mail 20s
2542 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002543
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020025443.7. Programs
2545-------------
2546In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2547master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2548managed the same way as the workers.
2549
2550During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2551sequence as a worker:
2552
2553 - the master is re-executed
2554 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2555 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2556 instance of the program
2557
2558During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2559
2560program <name>
2561 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2562 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2563 the management guide).
2564
2565command <command> [arguments*]
2566 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2567 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2568 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2569 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2570
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002571user <user name>
2572 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2573 See also "group".
2574
2575group <group name>
2576 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2577 See also "user".
2578
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002579option start-on-reload
2580no option start-on-reload
2581 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2582 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2583 program section.
2584
2585
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010025863.8. HTTP-errors
2587----------------
2588
2589It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2590imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2591several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2592
2593http-errors <name>
2594 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2595 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2596
2597errorfile <code> <file>
2598 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2599
2600 Arguments :
2601 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02002602 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
2603 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002604
2605 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2606 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2607 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2608 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2609 before any chroot is performed.
2610
2611 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2612
2613 Example:
2614 http-errors website-1
2615 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2616 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2617 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2618
2619 http-errors website-2
2620 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2621 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2622 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2623
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020026243.9. Rings
2625----------
2626
2627It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
2628servers or traces.
2629
2630ring <ringname>
2631 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
2632
2633description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002634 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002635 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
2636
2637format <format>
2638 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
2639
2640 Arguments:
2641 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
2642 one of the following :
2643
2644 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
2645 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
2646 designed to be used with a local log server.
2647
2648 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
2649 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2650 used in containers or during development, where the severity
2651 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
2652 is the default.
2653
2654 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
2655 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
2656
2657 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
2658 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
2659
2660 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2661 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
2662 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
2663 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
2664 logger consumes.
2665
2666 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2667 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
2668 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2669 used with a local log server.
2670
2671maxlen <length>
2672 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
2673 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
2674 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
2675
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002676server <name> <address> [param*]
2677 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
2678 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
2679 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
2680 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
2681 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
2682 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
2683 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
2684 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
2685 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002686 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
2687 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002688
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002689size <size>
2690 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
2691 set to BUFSIZE.
2692
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002693timeout connect <timeout>
2694 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2695
2696 Arguments :
2697 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2698 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2699 as explained at the top of this document.
2700
2701timeout server <timeout>
2702 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
2703
2704 Arguments :
2705 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2706 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2707 as explained at the top of this document.
2708
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002709 Example:
2710 global
2711 log ring@myring local7
2712
2713 ring myring
2714 description "My local buffer"
2715 format rfc3164
2716 maxlen 1200
2717 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002718 timeout connect 5s
2719 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002720 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002721
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002722
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020027234. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002724----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002725
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002726Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002727 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002728 - frontend <name>
2729 - backend <name>
2730 - listen <name>
2731
2732A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2733its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2734section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002735section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002736
2737A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2738connections.
2739
2740A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2741to forward incoming connections.
2742
2743A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2744parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2745
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002746All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2747'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2748case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2749
2750Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2751logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2752proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2753However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2754name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2755
2756Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2757and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002758bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002759protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2760modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2761arbitrary criteria.
2762
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002763In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2764a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002765the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002766
2767 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2768 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2769 between responses and new requests.
2770
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002771 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2772 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2773 client-facing connection remains open.
2774
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002775 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2776 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002777
2778The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2779frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2780following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002781weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002782
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002783 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002784
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002785 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2786 ----+-----+-----+----
2787 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2788 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002789 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2790 ----+-----+-----+----
2791 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002792
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002793
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002794
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020027954.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2796--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002797
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002798The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2799limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2800they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2801limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002802marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002803option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002804and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2805with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2806specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002807
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002808
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002809 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2810------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2811acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002812backlog X X X -
2813balance X - X X
2814bind - X X -
2815bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002816capture cookie - X X -
2817capture request header - X X -
2818capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09002819clitcpka-cnt X X X -
2820clitcpka-idle X X X -
2821clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002822compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002823cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002824declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002825default-server X - X X
2826default_backend X X X -
2827description - X X X
2828disabled X X X X
2829dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002830email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002831email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002832email-alert mailers X X X X
2833email-alert myhostname X X X X
2834email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002835enabled X X X X
2836errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002837errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002838errorloc X X X X
2839errorloc302 X X X X
2840-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2841errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002842force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002843filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002844fullconn X - X X
2845grace X X X X
2846hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01002847http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02002848http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002849http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002850http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002851http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02002852http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002853http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002854http-check set-var X - X X
2855http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02002856http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002857http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002858http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002859http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002860http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002861id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002862ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002863load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002864log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002865log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002866log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002867log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002868max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002869maxconn X X X -
2870mode X X X X
2871monitor fail - X X -
2872monitor-net X X X -
2873monitor-uri X X X -
2874option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2875option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2876option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2877option allbackups (*) X - X X
2878option checkcache (*) X - X X
2879option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2880option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02002881option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002882option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2883option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002884-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2885option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002886option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2887option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002888option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002889option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002890option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002891option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002892option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002893option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2894option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2895option httpchk X - X X
2896option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002897option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002898option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002899option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002900option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002901option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002902option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2903option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2904option logasap (*) X X X -
2905option mysql-check X - X X
2906option nolinger (*) X X X X
2907option originalto X X X X
2908option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002909option pgsql-check X - X X
2910option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002911option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002912option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002913option smtpchk X - X X
2914option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2915option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2916option splice-request (*) X X X X
2917option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002918option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002919option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2920option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2921-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002922option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002923option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2924option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2925option tcpka X X X X
2926option tcplog X X X X
2927option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002928external-check command X - X X
2929external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002930persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2931rate-limit sessions X X X -
2932redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002933-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002934retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002935retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002936server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002937server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002938server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002939source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09002940srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
2941srvtcpka-idle X - X X
2942srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002943stats admin - X X X
2944stats auth X X X X
2945stats enable X X X X
2946stats hide-version X X X X
2947stats http-request - X X X
2948stats realm X X X X
2949stats refresh X X X X
2950stats scope X X X X
2951stats show-desc X X X X
2952stats show-legends X X X X
2953stats show-node X X X X
2954stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002955-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2956stick match - - X X
2957stick on - - X X
2958stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002959stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002960stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02002961tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02002962tcp-check connect X - X X
2963tcp-check expect X - X X
2964tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02002965tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02002966tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02002967tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02002968tcp-check set-var X - X X
2969tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002970tcp-request connection - X X -
2971tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002972tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002973tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002974tcp-response content - - X X
2975tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002976timeout check X - X X
2977timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002978timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002979timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002980timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2981timeout http-request X X X X
2982timeout queue X - X X
2983timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002984timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002985timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002986timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002987transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002988unique-id-format X X X -
2989unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002990use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002991use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002992use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002993------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2994 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002995
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002996
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020029974.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2998---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002999
3000This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3001
3002
3003acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3004 Declare or complete an access list.
3005 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3006 no | yes | yes | yes
3007 Example:
3008 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3009 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3010 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3011
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003012 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003013
3014
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003015backlog <conns>
3016 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3018 yes | yes | yes | no
3019 Arguments :
3020 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3021 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003022 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003023
3024 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3025 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3026 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3027 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3028 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3029 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3030 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3031 backlog parameter.
3032
3033 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3034 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3035 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3036
3037 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3038
3039
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003040balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003041balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003042 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3043 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3044 yes | no | yes | yes
3045 Arguments :
3046 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3047 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3048 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3049 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3050
3051 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3052 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3053 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3054 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003055 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003056 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003057 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3058 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3059 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3060 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3061 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3062 it, so that you don't worry.
3063
3064 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3065 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3066 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3067 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3068 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3069 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3070 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3071 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003072
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003073 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3074 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3075 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3076 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3077 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3078 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3079 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
3080 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
3081
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003082 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003083 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003084 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3085 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003086 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003087 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3088 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3089 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3090 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3091 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003092 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3093 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3094 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3095 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3096 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3097 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003098
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003099 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3100 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3101 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3102 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3103 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3104 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3105 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3106 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003107 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003108 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003109 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3110 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3111 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003112
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003113 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3114 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3115 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3116 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3117 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3118 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3119 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3120 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3121 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3122 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3123 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3124 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003125
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003126 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003127 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3128 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3129 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3130 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3131 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3132 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3133 URIs start with a leading "/".
3134
3135 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3136 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3137 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3138 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3139
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003140 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003141 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3142
3143 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003144 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3145 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003146 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3147 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3148 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3149 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003150 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003151 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3152 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003153
3154 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3155 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3156 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3157 server will receive the request.
3158
3159 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3160 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3161 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3162 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3163 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003164 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3165 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3166 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003167
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003168 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3169 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3170 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3171 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3172 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003173
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003174 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003175 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3176 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3177 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3178
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003179 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3180 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3181 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3182
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003183 random
3184 random(<draws>)
3185 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003186 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3187 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3188 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3189 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003190 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3191 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3192 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3193 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3194 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3195 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3196 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3197 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3198 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3199 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3200 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3201 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3202 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3203 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3204 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3205 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3206 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3207 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3208 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3209 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003210
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003211 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003212 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003213 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3214 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3215 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3216 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3217 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3218 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003219 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003220 used instead.
3221
3222 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3223 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3224 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3225 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3226
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003227 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3228 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3229 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3230
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003231 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003232
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003233 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003234 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3235 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003236
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003237 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3238 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3239 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003240
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003241 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003242 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003243 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3244 NTLM relies on.
3245
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003246 Examples :
3247 balance roundrobin
3248 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003249 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003250 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3251 balance hdr(host)
3252 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003253
3254 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3255 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3256
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003257 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003258 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3259 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3260 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003261 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003262
3263 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3264 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3265 defaults to 16 kB.
3266
3267 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3268 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3269
3270 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3271 Round Robin.
3272
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003273 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003274 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3275 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3276 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3277
3278 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3279
3280 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003281 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003282 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3283 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3284 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003285
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003286 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003287
3288
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003289bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3290bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003291 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3293 no | yes | yes | no
3294 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003295 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3296 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3297 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3298 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003299 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003300 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3301 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3302 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3303 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3304 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3305 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
3306 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003307 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3308 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3309 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3310 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3311 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3312 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3313 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003314 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3315 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3316 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003317 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3318 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3319 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3320 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003321 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3322 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3323 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003324
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003325 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3326 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003327 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3328 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3329 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003330 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3331 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3332 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3333 the range.
3334
3335 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3336 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3337 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3338 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3339 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3340 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3341 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003342 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003343 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003344
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003345 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003346 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003347 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3348 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3349 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3350 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3351 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3352 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3353
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003354 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3355 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3356 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3357 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003358
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003359 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3360 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3361 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3362 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3363 in a frontend.
3364
3365 Example :
3366 listen http_proxy
3367 bind :80,:443
3368 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003369 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003370
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003371 listen http_https_proxy
3372 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003373 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003374
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003375 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3376 bind ipv6@:80
3377 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3378 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3379
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003380 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003381 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003382
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003383 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3384 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3385 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3386 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3387 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3388
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003389 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003390 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003391
3392
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003393bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003394 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3396 yes | yes | yes | yes
3397 Arguments :
3398 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3399 may be used to override a default value.
3400
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003401 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003402 option may be combined with other numbers.
3403
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003404 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003405 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3406 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3407 missing from all processes.
3408
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003409 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003410 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003411 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3412 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3413 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3414 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3415 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003416 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003417
3418 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3419 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3420 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3421 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3422 and 'even' instances.
3423
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003424 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3425 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3426 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3427 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003428
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003429 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3430 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3431
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003432 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3433 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3434 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3435
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003436 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3437 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3438
3439 Example :
3440 listen app_ip1
3441 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003442 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003443
3444 listen app_ip2
3445 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003446 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003447
3448 listen management
3449 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003450 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003451
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003452 listen management
3453 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3454 bind-process 1-4
3455
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003456 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003457
3458
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003459capture cookie <name> len <length>
3460 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3462 no | yes | yes | no
3463 Arguments :
3464 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3465 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3466 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3467 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003468 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003469
3470 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3471 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3472 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3473 right if it exceeds <length>.
3474
3475 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3476 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3477 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3478 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3479
3480 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3481 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3482 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3483
3484 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3485 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3486 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003487 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3488 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3489 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003490
3491 Example:
3492 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3493
3494 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003495 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003496
3497
3498capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003499 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3501 no | yes | yes | no
3502 Arguments :
3503 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003504 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003505 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3506 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3507 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3508
3509 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3510 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3511 it exceeds <length>.
3512
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003513 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003514 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3515 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003516 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3517 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3518 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3519 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003520 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003521 environments to find where the request came from.
3522
3523 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3524 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3525 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3526 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003527
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003528 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3529 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3530 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3531 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3532 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003533
3534 Example:
3535 capture request header Host len 15
3536 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003537 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003538
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003539 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003540 about logging.
3541
3542
3543capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003544 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3546 no | yes | yes | no
3547 Arguments :
3548 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003549 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003550 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3551 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3552 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3553
3554 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3555 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3556 it exceeds <length>.
3557
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003558 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003559 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3560 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3561 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003562 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3563 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3564 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3565 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003566
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003567 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3568 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3569 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3570 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3571 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003572
3573 Example:
3574 capture response header Content-length len 9
3575 capture response header Location len 15
3576
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003577 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003578 about logging.
3579
3580
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003581clitcpka-cnt <count>
3582 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
3583 the connection on the client side.
3584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3585 yes | yes | yes | no
3586 Arguments :
3587 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
3588
3589 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
3590 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003591 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3592 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003593
3594 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
3595
3596
3597clitcpka-idle <timeout>
3598 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
3599 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
3600 client side.
3601 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3602 yes | yes | yes | no
3603 Arguments :
3604 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
3605 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
3606 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
3607 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
3608
3609 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
3610 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003611 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3612 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003613
3614 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
3615
3616
3617clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
3618 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
3619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3620 yes | yes | yes | no
3621 Arguments :
3622 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
3623 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
3624 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
3625 document.
3626
3627 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
3628 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003629 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3630 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003631
3632 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
3633
3634
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003635compression algo <algorithm> ...
3636compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003637compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003638 Enable HTTP compression.
3639 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3640 yes | yes | yes | yes
3641 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003642 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3643 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3644 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3645
3646 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003647 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3648 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3649 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003650
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003651 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003652 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003653
3654 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3655 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3656 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3657 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3658 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003659 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003660
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003661 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3662 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3663 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3664 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3665 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3666 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3667 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003668 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003669
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003670 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003671 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003672 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3673 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3674 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3675 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3676 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003677
3678 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3679 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3680 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3681 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3682 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003683 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3684 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3685 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3686 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3687 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003688 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3689 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003690
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003691 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003692 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3693 "Accept-Encoding" header
3694 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003695 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003696 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3697 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3698 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3699 "multipart"
3700 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3701 header
3702 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3703 and later
3704 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3705 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003706 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003707
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003708 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003709
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003710 Examples :
3711 compression algo gzip
3712 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003713
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003714
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003715cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003716 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3717 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003718 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003719 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3720 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3721 yes | no | yes | yes
3722 Arguments :
3723 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3724 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3725 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3726 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3727 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3728 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003729 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003730 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3731 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3732
3733 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3734 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3735 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3736 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3737 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3738 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003739 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3740 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003741 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003742 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3743 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003744
3745 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003746 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003747
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003748 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003749 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003750 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003751 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003752 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3753 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3754 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3755 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3756 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3757 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3758 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003759
3760 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3761 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3762 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3763 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3764 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3765 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3766 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3767 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3768 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003769 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003770 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3771 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3772 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003773
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003774 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3775 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3776 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003777 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3778 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3779 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3780 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003781 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3782 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3783 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003784
3785 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3786 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3787 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3788 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3789 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3790 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3791 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3792 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3793 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3794
3795 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3796 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3797 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3798 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3799 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3800 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3801 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3802 persistence cookie in the cache.
3803 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3804
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003805 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3806 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3807 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3808 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3809 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003810 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003811 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3812 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3813 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3814 they logout.
3815
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003816 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3817 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3818 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3819 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3820
3821 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3822 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3823 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3824 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3825 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3826 this attribute.
3827
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003828 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003829 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003830 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3831 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3832 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3833 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3834 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3835 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003836
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003837 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3838 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3839 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3840 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3841 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3842 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3843 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3844 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003845 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003846 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3847 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3848 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3849 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3850 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3851 the site.
3852
3853 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3854 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3855 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3856 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3857 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3858 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3859 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3860 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3861 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3862 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3863 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3864 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3865 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003866 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003867 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3868 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3869
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003870 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3871 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3872 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3873 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3874 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3875 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3876
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003877 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3878 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3879 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3880 repeated.
3881
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003882 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3883 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3884 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3885 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003886
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003887 Examples :
3888 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3889 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3890 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003891 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003892
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003893 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003894
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003895
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003896declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3897 Declares a capture slot.
3898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3899 no | yes | yes | no
3900 Arguments:
3901 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3902
3903 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3904 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3905 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3906 for use in the response.
3907
3908 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003909 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003910 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3911
3912
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003913default-server [param*]
3914 Change default options for a server in a backend
3915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3916 yes | no | yes | yes
3917 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003918 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3919 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3920 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3921 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003922
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003923 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003924 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3925
3926 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003927
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003928
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003929default_backend <backend>
3930 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3932 yes | yes | yes | no
3933 Arguments :
3934 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3935
3936 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3937 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3938 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3939 will catch all undetermined requests.
3940
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003941 Example :
3942
3943 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3944 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3945 default_backend dynamic
3946
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003947 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003948
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003949
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003950description <string>
3951 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3953 no | yes | yes | yes
3954 Arguments : string
3955
3956 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3957 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3958 it describes.
3959 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3960
3961
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003962disabled
3963 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3964 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3965 yes | yes | yes | yes
3966 Arguments : none
3967
3968 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3969 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3970 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3971 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3972 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3973 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3974 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3975
3976 See also : "enabled"
3977
3978
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003979dispatch <address>:<port>
3980 Set a default server address
3981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3982 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003983 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003984
3985 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3986 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3987 during start-up.
3988
3989 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3990 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3991 possible with normal servers.
3992
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003993 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003994 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3995 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3996 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3997 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3998
3999 See also : "server"
4000
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004001
4002dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4003 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4004 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4005 yes | no | yes | yes
4006 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4007
4008 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004009 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004010 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4011 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004012 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004013 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004014
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004015enabled
4016 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4018 yes | yes | yes | yes
4019 Arguments : none
4020
4021 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4022 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4023
4024 See also : "disabled"
4025
4026
4027errorfile <code> <file>
4028 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4029 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4030 yes | yes | yes | yes
4031 Arguments :
4032 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004033 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004034 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004035
4036 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004037 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004038 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004039 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4040 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004041
4042 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4043 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4044 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4045
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004046 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4047
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004048 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4049 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4050 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4051 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4052 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4053 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4054 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4055 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4056 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004057
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004058 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4059 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4060 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004061 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004062 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4063
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004064 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004065
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004066 Example :
4067 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004068 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004069 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4070 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4071
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004072
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004073errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4074 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4075 section.
4076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4077 yes | yes | yes | yes
4078 Arguments :
4079 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4080
4081 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004082 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004083 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004084
4085 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4086 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4087 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4088 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4089 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004090 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004091 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4092
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004093 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4094 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004095
4096 Example :
4097 errorfiles generic
4098 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4099
4100
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004101errorloc <code> <url>
4102errorloc302 <code> <url>
4103 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4105 yes | yes | yes | yes
4106 Arguments :
4107 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004108 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004109 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004110
4111 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4112 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4113 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4114 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004115 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004116
4117 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4118 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4119 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4120
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004121 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4122
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004123 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4124 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4125 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4126 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004127 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004128 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4129 request.
4130
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004131 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004132
4133
4134errorloc303 <code> <url>
4135 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4137 yes | yes | yes | yes
4138 Arguments :
4139 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004140 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004141 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004142
4143 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4144 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4145 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4146 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004147 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004148
4149 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4150 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4151 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4152
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004153 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4154
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004155 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4156 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4157 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4158 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004159 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004160
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004161 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004162
4163
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004164email-alert from <emailaddr>
4165 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004166 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004167 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4168 yes | yes | yes | yes
4169
4170 Arguments :
4171
4172 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4173
4174 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4175 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4176
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004177 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004178 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4179 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004180
4181
4182email-alert level <level>
4183 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4184 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4185 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4186 yes | yes | yes | yes
4187
4188 Arguments :
4189
4190 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4191 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4192 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4193
4194 By default level is alert
4195
4196 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4197 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4198 for the proxy.
4199
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004200 Alerts are sent when :
4201
4202 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4203 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4204 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4205 is notice or lower
4206 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4207 and a health check status update occurs
4208
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004209 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4210 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004211 section 3.6 about mailers.
4212
4213
4214email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4215 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4216 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4217 yes | yes | yes | yes
4218
4219 Arguments :
4220
4221 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4222
4223 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4224 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4225
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004226 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4227 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004228
4229
4230email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4231 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4232 mailers.
4233 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4234 yes | yes | yes | yes
4235
4236 Arguments :
4237
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004238 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004239
4240 By default the systems hostname is used.
4241
4242 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4243 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4244 for the proxy.
4245
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004246 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4247 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004248
4249
4250email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004251 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004252 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4253 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4254 yes | yes | yes | yes
4255
4256 Arguments :
4257
4258 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4259
4260 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4261 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4262
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004263 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004264 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4265
4266
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004267force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4268 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4269 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004270 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004271
4272 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4273 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4274 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4275 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4276 marked down for maintenance operations.
4277
4278 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4279 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4280 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4281 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4282 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4283 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4284 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4285 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4286 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4287
4288 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4289 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4290 is used.
4291
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004292 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004293 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004294
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004295
4296filter <name> [param*]
4297 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4299 no | yes | yes | yes
4300 Arguments :
4301 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4302 referenced in section 9.
4303
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004304 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004305 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004306 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4307 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004308
4309 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4310 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4311
4312 Example:
4313 listen
4314 bind *:80
4315
4316 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4317 filter compression
4318 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4319
4320 compression algo gzip
4321 compression offload
4322
4323 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4324
4325 See also : section 9.
4326
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004327
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004328fullconn <conns>
4329 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4330 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4331 yes | no | yes | yes
4332 Arguments :
4333 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4334 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4335
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004336 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004337 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004338 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004339 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4340 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4341 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4342 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4343 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004344 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004345
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004346 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4347 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004348 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4349 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4350 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004351
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004352 Example :
4353 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4354 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4355 # connections.
4356 backend dynamic
4357 fullconn 10000
4358 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4359 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4360
4361 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4362
4363
4364grace <time>
4365 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4366 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004367 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004368 Arguments :
4369 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4370 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4371 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4372
4373 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4374 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004375 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004376 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4377
4378 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4379 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4380 simplify it.
4381
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004382
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004383hash-balance-factor <factor>
4384 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4386 yes | no | no | yes
4387 Arguments :
4388 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4389 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004390 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004391
4392 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4393 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4394 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4395 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4396 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4397 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4398 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4399
4400 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4401 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4402 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4403 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4404 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4405
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004406 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4407 consistent hashing mechanism.
4408
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004409 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4410
4411
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004412hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004413 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4415 yes | no | yes | yes
4416 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004417 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4418 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004419
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004420 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4421 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4422 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4423 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4424 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4425 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4426 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4427 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4428 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4429 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004430
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004431 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4432 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4433 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4434 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4435 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4436 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4437 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4438 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4439 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4440 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4441 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4442 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4443 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004444 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4445 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004446
4447 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4448
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004449 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004450 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4451 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4452 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004453 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4454 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4455 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004456
4457 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4458 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004459 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4460 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4461 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4462 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4463
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004464 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4465 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4466 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4467 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4468 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4469 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4470 parameter.
4471
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004472 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4473 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4474 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4475 used on strings.
4476
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004477 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4478
4479 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4480 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4481 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4482 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4483 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4484 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4485 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4486 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4487 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4488 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4489 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4490 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004491
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004492 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4493 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4494 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004495
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004496 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004497
4498
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004499http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4500 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4501 ones).
4502
4503 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4504 no | yes | yes | yes
4505
4506 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4507 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4508 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4509 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4510 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4511 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4512
4513 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4514 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4515 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4516
4517 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4518 below.
4519
4520 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4521 instance.
4522
4523 Example:
4524 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4525 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4526 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4527
4528http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4529
4530 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4531 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4532 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4533 example, or to pass some internal information.
4534 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4535 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4536 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4537
4538http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4539
4540 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4541 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4542
4543http-after-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4544
4545 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
4546
4547http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4548 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4549
4550 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4551
4552 Example:
4553 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4554
4555 # applied to:
4556 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4557
4558 # outputs:
4559 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4560
4561 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4562
4563http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4564 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4565
4566 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4567
4568 Example:
4569 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4570
4571 # applied to:
4572 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4573
4574 # outputs:
4575 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4576
4577http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4578
4579 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4580 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4581 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4582
4583http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4584 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4585
4586 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4587 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4588 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4589 fallback.
4590
4591 Example:
4592 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4593 http-response set-status 431
4594 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4595 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4596
4597http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4598
4599 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4600 inline.
4601
4602 Arguments:
4603 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4604 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4605 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4606 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4607 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4608 (request and response)
4609 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4610 processing
4611 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4612 processing
4613 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4614 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4615 and '_'.
4616
4617 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4618 followed by some converters.
4619
4620 Example:
4621 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4622
4623http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
4624
4625 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4626 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4627 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4628 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4629 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004630 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004631 processing.
4632
4633 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
4634 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004635 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004636 rules evaluation.
4637
4638http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4639
4640 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
4641 details about <var-name>.
4642
4643 Example:
4644 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4645
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004646
4647http-check comment <string>
4648 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
4649 it fails.
4650 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4651 yes | no | yes | yes
4652
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004653 Arguments :
4654 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
4655 rule fails.
4656
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004657 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
4658 user-friendly error reporting.
4659
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004660 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004661 "http-check expect".
4662
4663
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004664http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
4665 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004666 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004667 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
4668 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4669 yes | no | yes | yes
4670
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004671 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004672 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4673
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004674 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004675 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004676
4677 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
4678 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
4679 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
4680 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
4681
4682 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
4683
4684 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
4685
4686 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
4687
4688 ssl opens a ciphered connection
4689
4690 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
4691
4692 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
4693 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
4694 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
4695 is used.
4696
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004697 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
4698 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
4699 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
4700 haproxy -vv.
4701
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004702 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
4703
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004704 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
4705 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
4706 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
4707 different ports or with different servers.
4708
4709 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
4710 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
4711 the port with a "http-check connect".
4712
4713 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
4714 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
4715 do.
4716
4717 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
4718 unset-var or comment rules.
4719
4720 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004721 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
4722 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
4723 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
4724 option httpchk
4725
4726 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004727 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004728 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004729 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004730 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004731 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004732
4733 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
4734
4735 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004736
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004737
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004738http-check disable-on-404
4739 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004741 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004742 Arguments : none
4743
4744 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4745 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4746 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4747 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4748 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4749 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4750 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4751 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004752 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4753 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4754 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4755
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004756 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004757
4758
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004759http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004760 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
4761 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
4762 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004763 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004765 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004766
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004767 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004768 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4769
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004770 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
4771 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
4772 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
4773 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
4774 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
4775 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
4776 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
4777 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
4778 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
4779 result is always conclusive.
4780
4781 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4782 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
4783 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004784 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
4785 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
4786 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
4787 example 404 with disable-on-404
4788 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
4789 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
4790 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004791
4792 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4793 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004794 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
4795 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
4796 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
4797 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
4798 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
4799 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004800
4801 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4802 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004803 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
4804 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
4805 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
4806 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004807 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
4808
4809 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4810 informational message reported in logs if the expect
4811 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
4812 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
4813
4814 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4815 informational message reported in logs if an error
4816 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
4817 log-format string.
4818
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004819 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004820 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
4821 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004822 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4823 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4824 details on the supported keywords.
4825
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004826 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
4827 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
4828 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
4829 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004830
4831 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4832 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4833 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4834 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4835 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4836
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004837 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
4838 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
4839 codes. A health check response will be considered as
4840 valid if the response's status code matches any status
4841 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
4842 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4843 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004844
4845 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004846 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004847 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4848 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4849 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4850 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4851
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004852 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
4853 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004854 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
4855 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
4856 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
4857 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
4858 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
4859 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
4860 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
4861 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004862 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
4863 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
4864 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
4865 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
4866 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
4867 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
4868 insensitive on the header names.
4869
4870 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
4871 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
4872 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
4873 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
4874 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
4875 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004876
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004877 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004878 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004879 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4880 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4881 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4882 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4883 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004884 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004885 trace).
4886
4887 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004888 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004889 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4890 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4891 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4892 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4893 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004894 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004895
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02004896 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
4897 A health check response will be considered valid if the
4898 response's body contains the string resulting of the
4899 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
4900 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4901 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
4902
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004903 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4904 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4905 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4906 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4907 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4908 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4909 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4910 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4911
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004912 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
4913 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
4914 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
4915 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
4916 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004917
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004918 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4919 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4920
4921 Examples :
4922 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004923 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004924
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004925 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
4926 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
4927
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004928 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004929 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004930
4931 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004932 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004933
4934 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004935 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004936
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004937 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004938 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004939
4940
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02004941http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02004942 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
4943 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004944 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
4945 health checks.
4946 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4947 yes | no | yes | yes
4948 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004949 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4950
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004951 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
4952 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
4953 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
4954 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
4955 to invent non-standard ones.
4956
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02004957 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
4958 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
4959 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
4960 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4961
4962 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
4963 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
4964 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4965 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004966
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02004967 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004968 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004969 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004970 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
4971 to add it.
4972
4973 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4974 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
4975 to the log-format rules.
4976
4977 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
4978 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
4979 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004980
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02004981 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
4982 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
4983 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
4984 request.
4985
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004986 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
4987 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
4988 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02004989 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
4990 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
4991 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
4992 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004993 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004994 "http-check expect" directive is defined independently of this directive, just
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004995 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
4996
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004997 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4998 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02004999 header should not be present in the request provided by "http-check send". If
5000 so, it will be ignored.
5001
5002 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5003 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5004 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5005 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5006 configured request authority.
5007
5008 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5009 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005010
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005011 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005012
5013
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005014http-check send-state
5015 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5017 yes | no | yes | yes
5018 Arguments : none
5019
5020 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
5021 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
5022 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5023 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
5024 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
5025
5026 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5027 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5028 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5029 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5030 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005031 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5032 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5033 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5034
5035 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5036 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5037 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5038
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005039 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5040 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5041 checked in multiple backends.
5042
5043 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
5044 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5045
5046 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5047 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5048 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5049 one fails.
5050
5051 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5052 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5053 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5054
5055 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5056 server's queue.
5057
5058 Example of a header received by the application server :
5059 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5060 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5061
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005062 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5063 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005064
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005065
5066http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005067 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005068 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5069 yes | no | yes | yes
5070
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005071 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005072 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5073 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5074 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5075 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5076 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5077 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5078 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5079 and '-'.
5080
5081 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5082
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005083 Examples :
5084 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005085
5086
5087http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005088 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005089 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5090 yes | no | yes | yes
5091
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005092 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005093 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5094 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5095 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5096 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5097 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5098 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5099 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5100 and '-'.
5101
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005102 Examples :
5103 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005104
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005105
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005106http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5107 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5108 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5109 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5110 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5112 yes | yes | yes | yes
5113 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005114 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005115 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005116 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
5117 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005118
5119 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5120 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5121 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5122 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5123
5124 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5125 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5126 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5127 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5128
5129 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5130 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5131 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5132 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5133 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5134 chroot is performed.
5135
5136 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5137 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5138 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5139 considered.
5140
5141 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5142 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5143 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5144 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5145 considered as a raw string.
5146
5147 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5148 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5149 "content-type".
5150
5151 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5152 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5153 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5154 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5155 evaluated as a log-format string.
5156
5157 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5158 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5159 argument to "content-type".
5160
5161 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5162 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5163 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5164 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5165
5166 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5167 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5168 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5169 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5170 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5171 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5172 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5173 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5174
5175 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5176 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5177 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5178
5179 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5180 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5181
5182
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005183http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005184 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5185
5186 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5187 no | yes | yes | yes
5188
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005189 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5190 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5191 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5192 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5193 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005194
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005195 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5196 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005197
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005198 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005199
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005200 Example:
5201 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5202 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5203 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005204
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005205 http-request allow if nagios
5206 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5207 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5208 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005209
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005210 Example:
5211 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5212 acl add path /addacl
5213 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005214
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005215 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005216
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005217 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5218 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005219
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005220 Example:
5221 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5222 acl setmap path /setmap
5223 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005224
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005225 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005226
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005227 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5228 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005229
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005230 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5231 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005232
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005233http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005234
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005235 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5236 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5237 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5238 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5239 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5240 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5241 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5242 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005243
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005244http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005245
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005246 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5247 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5248 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5249 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5250 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5251 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5252 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5253 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005254
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005255http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005256
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005257 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5258 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005259
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005260
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005261http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005262
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005263 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5264 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5265 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5266 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5267 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005268
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005269 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5270 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5271 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5272 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5273 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5274 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5275 instead.
5276
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005277 Example:
5278 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5279 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005280
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005281http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005282
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005283 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005284
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005285http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5286 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005287
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005288 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5289 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5290 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5291 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5292 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5293 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5294 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5295 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5296 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005297
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005298 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5299 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5300 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005301 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5302
5303 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5304 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5305 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5306 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005307
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005308http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005309
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005310 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5311 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5312 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5313 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5314 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5315 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005316
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005317http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005318
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005319 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005320
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005321http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005322
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005323 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5324 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5325 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5326 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5327 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5328 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005329
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005330http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5331http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5332 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5333 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5334 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5335 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005336
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005337 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
5338 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5339 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005340 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005341 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5342 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5343 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005344 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005345 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005346
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005347http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5348 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5349 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5350 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5351
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005352http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5353
5354 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5355 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5356 pointed by <resolvers>.
5357 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5358 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5359 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5360 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5361 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5362 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5363 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5364 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5365 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5366 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5367 to 0.0.0.0.
5368
5369 Example:
5370 resolvers mydns
5371 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5372 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5373 timeout retry 1s
5374 hold valid 10s
5375 hold nx 3s
5376 hold other 3s
5377 hold obsolete 0s
5378 accepted_payload_size 8192
5379
5380 frontend fe
5381 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5382 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5383 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5384
5385 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5386 # which mean DNS resolution error
5387 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5388
5389 default_backend be
5390
5391 backend b_503
5392 # dummy backend used to return 503.
5393 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5394 # 503 error page to end users
5395
5396 backend be
5397 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5398 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5399 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5400 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
5401 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
5402
5403 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
5404 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
5405
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005406http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5407
5408 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
5409 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
5410 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
5411 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01005412 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
5413 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005414
5415 See RFC 8297 for more information.
5416
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005417http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005418
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005419 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
5420 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
5421 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
5422 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
5423 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005424
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005425http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005426
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005427 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
5428 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
5429 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
5430 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005431
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005432http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5433 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02005434
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005435 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005436 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
5437 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
5438 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
5439 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
5440 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02005441
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005442 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
5443 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
5444 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
5445 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
5446 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005447
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005448 Example:
5449 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
5450
5451 # applied to:
5452 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5453
5454 # outputs:
5455 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5456
5457 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005458
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005459 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
5460
5461 # applied to:
5462 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005463
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005464 # outputs:
5465 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005466
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005467http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5468 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5469
5470 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
5471 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
5472 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
5473 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
5474
5475 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5476 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5477 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
5478
5479 Example:
5480 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5481 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
5482
5483 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
5484 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
5485
5486 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
5487 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
5488 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
5489 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
5490
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005491http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5492 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5493
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005494 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
5495 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
5496 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
5497 against.
5498
5499 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5500 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5501 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005502
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005503 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
5504 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
5505 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
5506 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
5507 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
5508 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
5509 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
5510 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
5511 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005512 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
5513 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005514
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005515 Example:
5516 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
5517 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005518
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005519 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5520 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005521
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005522http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5523 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005524
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005525 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5526 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
5527 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
5528 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005529
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005530 Example:
5531 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005532
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005533 # applied to:
5534 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005535
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005536 # outputs:
5537 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005538
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005539http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5540 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5541 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005542 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005543 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5544
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005545 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005546 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5547 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005548 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005549 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005550 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005551 are followed to create the response :
5552
5553 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5554 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5555 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5556 ignored.
5557
5558 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5559 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005560 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005561 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
5562 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005563
5564 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5565 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5566 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005567 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005568 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005569
5570 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5571 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5572 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005573 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005574 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
5575 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005576
5577 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5578 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5579 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5580 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5581 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5582 as a raw content.
5583
5584 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5585 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5586 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5587 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5588 considered as a raw string.
5589
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005590 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
5591 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5592 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5593 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5594
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005595 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5596 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005597 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005598
5599 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5600
5601 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005602 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005603 if { path /ping }
5604
5605 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
5606 if { path /favicon.ico }
5607
5608 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
5609 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
5610 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
5611
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005612http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5613http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005614
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005615 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5616 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5617 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005618
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005619http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5620 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005621
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005622 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5623 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5624 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5625 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005626
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005627http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005628
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005629 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
5630 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
5631 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
5632 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
5633 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005634
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005635 Arguments:
5636 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5637 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005638
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005639 Example:
5640 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
5641 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005642
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005643 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
5644 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005645
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005646http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005647
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005648 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
5649 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
5650 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005651
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005652 Arguments:
5653 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5654 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005655
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005656 Example:
5657 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
5658 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005659
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005660 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
5661 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
5662 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005663
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005664http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005665
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005666 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
5667 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5668 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5669 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
5670 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005671
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005672 Example:
5673 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
5674 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
5675 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
5676 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
5677 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
5678 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
5679 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
5680 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
5681 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005682
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005683http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005684
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005685 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5686 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5687 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5688 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
5689 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005690
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005691http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5692 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005693
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005694 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5695 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5696 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5697 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5698 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
5699 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
5700 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
5701 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
5702 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005703
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005704http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005705
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005706 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5707 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5708 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5709 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
5710 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
5711 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
5712 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005713
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005714http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005715
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005716 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
5717 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
5718 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005719
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005720http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005721
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005722 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
5723 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
5724 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
5725 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
5726 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
5727 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5728 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5729 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005730
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005731http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005732
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005733 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
5734 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
5735 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
5736 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
5737 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
5738 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005739
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005740 Example :
5741 # prepend the host name before the path
5742 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005743
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005744http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02005745
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005746 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
5747 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
5748 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5749 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
5750 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005751
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005752http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005753
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005754 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
5755 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
5756 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5757 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
5758 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
5759 values have higher priority.
5760 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
5761 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
5762 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
5763 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
5764 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005765
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005766http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005767
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005768 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
5769 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
5770 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
5771 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
5772 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
5773 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
5774 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005775
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005776 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005777
5778 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005779 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
5780 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005781
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005782http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5783 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
5784 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
5785 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005786 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
5787 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005788
5789 Arguments :
5790 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5791 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005792
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005793 See also "option forwardfor".
5794
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005795 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005796 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
5797 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
5798
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005799 # After the masking this will track connections
5800 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
5801 http-request track-sc0 src
5802
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005803 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
5804 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
5805
5806http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5807
5808 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
5809 expression.
5810
5811 Arguments:
5812 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5813 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005814
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005815 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005816 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
5817 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
5818
5819 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
5820 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
5821 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
5822
5823http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5824
5825 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5826 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
5827 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
5828 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
5829 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
5830 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
5831 information from the request.
5832
5833 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5834
5835http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5836
5837 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
5838 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
5839 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
5840 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
5841 path and the query string.
5842 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
5843
5844http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5845
5846 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5847 inline.
5848
5849 Arguments:
5850 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5851 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5852 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5853 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5854 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5855 (request and response)
5856 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5857 processing
5858 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5859 processing
5860 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5861 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
5862 and '_'.
5863
5864 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5865 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005866
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005867 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005868 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005869
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005870http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
5871 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005872
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005873 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5874 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5875 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5876 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5877 agent name must be used.
5878
5879 Arguments:
5880 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
5881
5882 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5883 configuration.
5884
5885http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5886
5887 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5888 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5889 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5890 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5891 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5892 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5893 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5894 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5895 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5896 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5897 action.
5898 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5899 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5900 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5901 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5902 you fully understand how it works.
5903
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005904http-request strict-mode { on | off }
5905
5906 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5907 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5908 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5909 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5910 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005911 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005912 processing.
5913
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005914 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005915 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5916 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
5917 rules evaluation.
5918
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005919http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5920http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5921 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5922 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5923 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5924 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005925
5926 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
5927 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
5928 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005929 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
5930 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
5931 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
5932 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
5933 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
5934 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
5935 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
5936 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
5937 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
5938 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005939 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005940 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5941 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5942 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
5943 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5944 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005945
5946http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5947http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5948http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5949
5950 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
5951 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
5952 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
5953 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
5954 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
5955 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5956 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
5957 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
5958 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5959 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
5960 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
5961 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
5962
5963 Arguments :
5964 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
5965 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
5966 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
5967 select which table entry to update the counters.
5968
5969 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
5970 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
5971 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
5972 that table until the session ends.
5973
5974 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
5975 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
5976 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
5977 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
5978 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
5979 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
5980 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
5981 useful information.
5982
5983 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
5984 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
5985 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
5986 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
5987 checks that make use of it.
5988
5989http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5990
5991 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005992
5993 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005994 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005995
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01005996http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5997
5998 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
5999 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6000 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6001 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6002 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6003 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6004
6005 Arguments :
6006 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6007
6008 Example:
6009 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6010
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006011http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006012
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006013 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6014 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6015 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006016
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006017
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006018http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006019 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6020
6021 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6022 no | yes | yes | yes
6023
6024 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6025 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6026 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6027 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6028 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6029 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6030
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006031 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6032 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006033
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006034 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006035
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006036 Example:
6037 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006038
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006039 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006040
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006041 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6042 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006043
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006044 Example:
6045 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006046
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006047 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006048
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006049 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6050 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006051
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006052 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6053 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006054
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006055http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006056
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006057 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6058 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6059 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6060 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6061 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6062 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6063 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6064 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006065
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006066http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006067
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006068 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6069 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6070 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6071 example, or to pass some internal information.
6072 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6073 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6074 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006075
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006076http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006077
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006078 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6079 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006080
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006081http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006082
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006083 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006084
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006085http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006086
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006087 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6088 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6089 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
6090 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
6091 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
6092 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
6093 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006094
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006095 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
6096 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
6097 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
6098 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
6099 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006100
6101 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6102 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6103 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6104 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006105
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006106http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006107
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006108 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6109 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6110 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6111 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6112 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6113 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006114
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006115http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006116
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006117 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006118
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006119http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006120
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006121 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6122 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6123 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6124 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6125 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6126 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006127
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006128http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6129http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6130 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6131 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6132 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6133 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006134
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006135 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
6136 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6137 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006138 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006139 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
6140 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
6141 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01006142 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006143 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006144
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006145http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006146
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006147 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
6148 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
6149 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
6150 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
6151 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
6152 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006153
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006154http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6155 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006156
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006157 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
6158 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006159
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006160 Example:
6161 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02006162
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006163 # applied to:
6164 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006165
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006166 # outputs:
6167 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006168
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006169 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006170
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006171http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6172 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006173
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01006174 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006175 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006176
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006177 Example:
6178 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006179
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006180 # applied to:
6181 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006182
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006183 # outputs:
6184 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006185
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006186http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6187 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6188 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006189 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006190 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6191
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006192 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006193 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6194 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006195 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006196 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006197 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006198 are followed to create the response :
6199
6200 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6201 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6202 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6203 ignored.
6204
6205 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6206 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006207 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006208 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
6209 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006210
6211 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6212 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6213 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006214 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006215 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006216
6217 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6218 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6219 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006220 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006221 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
6222 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006223
6224 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6225 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6226 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6227 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6228 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6229 as a raw content.
6230
6231 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6232 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6233 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6234 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6235 considered as a raw string.
6236
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006237 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
6238 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6239 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6240 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6241
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006242 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6243 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006244 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006245
6246 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
6247
6248 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006249 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006250 if { status eq 404 }
6251
6252 http-response return content-type text/plain \
6253 string "This is the end !" \
6254 if { status eq 500 }
6255
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006256http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6257http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08006258
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006259 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6260 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6261 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006262
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006263http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6264 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006265
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006266 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6267 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6268 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6269 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006270
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006271http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006272
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006273 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6274 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6275 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6276 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6277 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006278
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006279 Arguments:
6280 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006281
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006282 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6283 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006284
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006285http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006286
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006287 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
6288 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
6289 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006290
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006291http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6292
6293 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6294 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6295 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6296 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
6297 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
6298
6299http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6300
6301 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6302 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6303 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6304 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6305 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
6306 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6307 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6308 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
6309 be triggered by an HTTP response.
6310
6311http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6312
6313 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6314 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6315 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6316 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
6317 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
6318 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
6319 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
6320
6321http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6322
6323 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
6324 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
6325 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
6326 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
6327 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
6328 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6329 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6330 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
6331
6332http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6333 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6334
6335 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
6336 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
6337 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
6338 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006339
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006340 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006341 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
6342 http-response set-status 431
6343 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
6344 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006345
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006346http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006347
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006348 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6349 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
6350 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
6351 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
6352 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
6353 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
6354 based on some information from the request.
6355
6356 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6357
6358http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6359
6360 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6361 inline.
6362
6363 Arguments:
6364 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6365 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6366 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6367 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6368 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6369 (request and response)
6370 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6371 processing
6372 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6373 processing
6374 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6375 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
6376 and '_'.
6377
6378 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6379 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006380
6381 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006382 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006383
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006384http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006385
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006386 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6387 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6388 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6389 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6390 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6391 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6392 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6393 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6394 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6395 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6396 action.
6397 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6398 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6399 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6400 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6401 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006402
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006403http-response strict-mode { on | off }
6404
6405 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6406 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6407 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6408 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6409 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006410 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006411 processing.
6412
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006413 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006414 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006415 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006416 rules evaluation.
6417
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006418http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6419http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6420http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006421
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006422 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
6423 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
6424 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
6425 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
6426 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
6427 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
6428
6429http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6430
6431 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
6432 about <var-name>.
6433
6434 Example:
6435 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
6436
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02006437
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006438http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
6439 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
6440
6441 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6442 yes | no | yes | yes
6443
6444 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006445 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
6446 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
6447 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006448
6449 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
6450
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006451 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
6452 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
6453 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
6454 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
6455 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
6456 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
6457 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
6458 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
6459 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
6460 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006461
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006462 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
6463 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
6464 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
6465 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
6466 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
6467 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
6468 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
6469 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006470
6471 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
6472 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
6473 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
6474 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
6475 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
6476 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
6477 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
6478 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02006479 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006480 downsides of rare connection failures.
6481
6482 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
6483 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
6484 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
6485 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
6486 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
6487 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006488 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006489 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
6490 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
6491 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
6492 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
6493 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
6494
6495 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006496 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
6497 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
6498 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006499
6500 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006501 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006502
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02006503 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
6504 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006505
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01006506 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006507
6508 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
6509 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
6510 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
6511
6512 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
6513
6514
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006515http-send-name-header [<header>]
6516 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006517 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6518 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006519 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006520 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
6521
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02006522 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
6523 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
6524 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
6525 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
6526 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
6527 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
6528 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
6529 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
6530 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
6531 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
6532 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
6533 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
6534 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
6535 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
6536 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
6537 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006538
6539 See also : "server"
6540
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006541id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006542 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
6543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6544 no | yes | yes | yes
6545 Arguments : none
6546
6547 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
6548 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
6549 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006550
6551
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006552ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
6553 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
6554 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01006555 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006556
6557 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
6558 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
6559 and running).
6560
6561 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
6562 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
6563 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006564 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006565 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
6566
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006567 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
6568 "unless" condition is met.
6569
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006570 Example:
6571 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
6572 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
6573 ignore-persist if url_static
6574
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006575 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
6576
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006577load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
6578 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
6579 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6580 yes | no | yes | yes
6581
6582 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
6583 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
6584 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006585 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006586 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
6587 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
6588 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
6589 over the stats socket and redirect output.
6590
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006591 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006592 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02006593 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006594
6595 Arguments:
6596 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
6597 named "server-state-file".
6598
6599 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
6600 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
6601 name is used as a file name.
6602
6603 none don't load any stat for this backend
6604
6605 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006606 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
6607 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
6608 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006609 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006610 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006611
6612 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
6613 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
6614
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006615 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006616
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006617 global
6618 stats socket /tmp/socket
6619 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006620
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006621 defaults
6622 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006623
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006624 backend bk
6625 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6626 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006627
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006628
6629 Then one can run :
6630
6631 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
6632
6633 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
6634
6635 1
6636 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6637 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6638 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6639
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006640 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006641
6642 global
6643 stats socket /tmp/socket
6644 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
6645
6646 defaults
6647 load-server-state-from-file local
6648
6649 backend bk
6650 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6651 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
6652
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006653
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006654 Then one can run :
6655
6656 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
6657
6658 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
6659
6660 1
6661 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6662 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6663 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6664
6665 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
6666 "show servers state"
6667
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006668
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006669log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006670log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
6671 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006672no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006673 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
6674 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6675 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006676
6677 Prefix :
6678 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
6679 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
6680 prefix does not allow arguments.
6681
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006682 Arguments :
6683 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
6684 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
6685 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
6686 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
6687 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
6688 parameter.
6689
6690 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
6691 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
6692
6693 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
6694 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6695 standard syslog port).
6696
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01006697 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
6698 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6699 standard syslog port).
6700
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006701 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
6702 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
6703 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006704 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006705
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006706 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
6707 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
6708 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
6709 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
6710 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
6711 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
6712 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
6713 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
6714 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
6715 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
6716 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
6717 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
6718 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
6719 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
6720 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
6721 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006722 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
6723 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006724
6725 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
6726 and "fd@2", see above.
6727
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02006728 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
6729 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
6730 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
6731 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
6732 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
6733 having the logs instantly available.
6734
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006735 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6736 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006737
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006738 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
6739 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
6740 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
6741 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
6742 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
6743 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
6744 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
6745 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
6746 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
6747 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006748 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006749
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006750 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
6751 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
6752 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
6753 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
6754 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
6755
6756 <sample_size>
6757 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
6758 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
6759 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
6760 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
6761 (see also <ranges> parameter).
6762
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01006763 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
6764 one of the following :
6765
6766 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
6767 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
6768
6769 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
6770 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
6771
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006772 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6773 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
6774 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
6775 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
6776 systemd logger consumes.
6777
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006778 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
6779 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
6780 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
6781 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
6782
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006783 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
6784
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006785 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
6786 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
6787 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
6788
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006789 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
6790 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
6791 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
6792 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006793
6794 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
6795 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
6796 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006797 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
6798 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
6799 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
6800 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
6801 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006802
6803 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
6804
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006805 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
6806 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
6807 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006808
6809 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
6810 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
6811 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
6812 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
6813
6814 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
6815 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006816
6817 Example :
6818 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006819 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
6820 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
6821 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006822 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
6823 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006824 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006825
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006826
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006827log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006828 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
6829 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6830 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006831
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006832 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
6833 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
6834 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
6835 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
6836 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006837
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006838 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
6839 "option httplog" directives.
6840
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02006841log-format-sd <string>
6842 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
6843 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6844 yes | yes | yes | no
6845
6846 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
6847 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
6848 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
6849 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
6850 which covers the log format string in depth.
6851
6852 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
6853 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
6854
6855 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
6856 log format to "rfc5424".
6857
6858 Example :
6859 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
6860
6861
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01006862log-tag <string>
6863 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
6864 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6865 yes | yes | yes | yes
6866
6867 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
6868 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
6869 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
6870 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
6871 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
6872 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
6873 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
6874 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
6875 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006876
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006877max-keep-alive-queue <value>
6878 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
6879 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6880 yes | no | yes | yes
6881
6882 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
6883 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
6884 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
6885 servers.
6886
6887 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
6888 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
6889 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
6890 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
6891 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006892 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006893 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
6894 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
6895 picking a different server.
6896
6897 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
6898 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
6899 even if they have to be queued.
6900
6901 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
6902 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
6903
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01006904max-session-srv-conns <nb>
6905 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
6906 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
6907 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006908
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006909maxconn <conns>
6910 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
6911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6912 yes | yes | yes | no
6913 Arguments :
6914 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
6915 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
6916 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
6917 closes.
6918
6919 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
6920 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
6921 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
6922 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01006923 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
6924 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
6925 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
6926 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006927
6928 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
6929 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
6930 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
6931
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01006932 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
6933 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02006934
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006935 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
6936
6937
6938mode { tcp|http|health }
6939 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
6940 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6941 yes | yes | yes | yes
6942 Arguments :
6943 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
6944 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
6945 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
6946 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
6947
6948 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
6949 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
6950 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
6951 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
6952 brings HAProxy most of its value.
6953
6954 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006955 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
6956 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
6957 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
6958 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
6959 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
6960 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
6961 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006962
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006963 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
6964 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
6965 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006966
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006967 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006968 defaults http_instances
6969 mode http
6970
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006971 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006972
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006973
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006974monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006975 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6977 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006978 Arguments :
6979 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
6980 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006981 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006982 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
6983 backend and its backup.
6984
6985 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
6986 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
6987 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
6988 servers in a list of backends.
6989
6990 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
6991 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
6992 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
6993 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
6994 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
6995 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
6996 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006997 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
6998 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006999
7000 Example:
7001 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007002 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007003 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7004 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7005 monitor-uri /site_alive
7006 monitor fail if site_dead
7007
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007008 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007009
7010
7011monitor-net <source>
7012 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
7013 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7014 yes | yes | yes | no
7015 Arguments :
7016 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
7017 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
7018 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
7019 followed by a mask.
7020
7021 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
7022 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007023 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007024 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
7025
7026 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
7027 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
7028 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
7029 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02007030 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
7031 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
7032 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007033
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02007034 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
7035 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
7036 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
7037 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
7038 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
7039 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007040
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01007041 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
7042 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007043
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007044 Example :
7045 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
7046 frontend www
7047 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
7048
7049 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
7050
7051
7052monitor-uri <uri>
7053 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7055 yes | yes | yes | no
7056 Arguments :
7057 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7058 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7059
7060 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7061 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7062 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7063 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7064 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7065 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7066 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7067 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7068
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007069 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007070 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
7071 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
7072 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
7073 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
7074 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
7075 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007076
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01007077 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
7078 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
7079 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
7080 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
7081
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007082 Example :
7083 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
7084 frontend www
7085 mode http
7086 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
7087
7088 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
7089
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007090
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007091option abortonclose
7092no option abortonclose
7093 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
7094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7095 yes | no | yes | yes
7096 Arguments : none
7097
7098 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
7099 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
7100 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
7101 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007102 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007103 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
7104 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
7105 encountered while delivering the response.
7106
7107 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
7108 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
7109 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
7110 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
7111 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
7112 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007113 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007114 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007115 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007116 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
7117 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
7118 still not served and not pollute the servers.
7119
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007120 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
7121 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007122 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
7123 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
7124 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
7125 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
7126 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
7127 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007128 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007129
7130 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7131 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7132
7133 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
7134
7135
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007136option accept-invalid-http-request
7137no option accept-invalid-http-request
7138 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
7139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7140 yes | yes | yes | no
7141 Arguments : none
7142
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007143 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007144 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007145 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007146 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7147 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7148 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7149 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7150 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007151 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
7152 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
7153 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
7154 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007155 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007156 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02007157 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
7158 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
7159 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007160
7161 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7162 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7163 been confirmed.
7164
7165 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7166 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007167 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
7168 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007169 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7170
7171 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7172 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7173
7174 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
7175 stats socket.
7176
7177
7178option accept-invalid-http-response
7179no option accept-invalid-http-response
7180 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
7181 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7182 yes | no | yes | yes
7183 Arguments : none
7184
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007185 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007186 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007187 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007188 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7189 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7190 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7191 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7192 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007193 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
7194 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
7195 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007196
7197 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7198 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7199 been confirmed.
7200
7201 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7202 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
7203 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
7204 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7205
7206 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7207 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7208
7209 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
7210 stats socket.
7211
7212
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007213option allbackups
7214no option allbackups
7215 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
7216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7217 yes | no | yes | yes
7218 Arguments : none
7219
7220 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
7221 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
7222 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
7223 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
7224 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
7225 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
7226 order between the backup servers anymore.
7227
7228 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
7229 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
7230
7231 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7232 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7233
7234
7235option checkcache
7236no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08007237 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7239 yes | no | yes | yes
7240 Arguments : none
7241
7242 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
7243 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007244 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007245 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
7246 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007247 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007248
7249 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007250 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007251 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007252 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
7253 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007254 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007255 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01007256 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
7257 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007258 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01007259 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
7260 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007261 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007262 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
7263 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
7264 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
7265 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
7266 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
7267 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
7268 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
7269 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
7270 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
7271
7272 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007273 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
7274 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
7275 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
7276 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007277
7278 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
7279 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007280 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007281 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007282
7283 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7284 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7285
7286
7287option clitcpka
7288no option clitcpka
7289 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
7290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7291 yes | yes | yes | no
7292 Arguments : none
7293
7294 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7295 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007296 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007297 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7298
7299 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7300 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7301 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7302 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7303
7304 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7305 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7306 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7307 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7308 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7309
7310 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7311
7312 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7313 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7314 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
7315
7316 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7317 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7318
7319 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
7320
7321
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007322option contstats
7323 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
7324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7325 yes | yes | yes | no
7326 Arguments : none
7327
7328 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
7329 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
7330 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
7331 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01007332 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
7333 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
7334 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
7335 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
7336 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007337
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02007338option disable-h2-upgrade
7339no option disable-h2-upgrade
7340 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
7341 connection.
7342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7343 yes | yes | yes | no
7344 Arguments : none
7345
7346 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
7347 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
7348 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
7349 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
7350 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be used to
7351 disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only supported
7352 for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to force the
7353 HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind line.
7354
7355 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7356 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007357
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007358option dontlog-normal
7359no option dontlog-normal
7360 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
7361 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7362 yes | yes | yes | no
7363 Arguments : none
7364
7365 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
7366 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
7367 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
7368 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
7369 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
7370 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
7371 logged.
7372
7373 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
7374 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
7375 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
7376
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007377 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007378 logging.
7379
7380
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007381option dontlognull
7382no option dontlognull
7383 Enable or disable logging of null connections
7384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7385 yes | yes | yes | no
7386 Arguments : none
7387
7388 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
7389 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
7390 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
7391 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
7392 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
7393 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007394 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
7395 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
7396 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007397
7398 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007399 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007400 would not be logged.
7401
7402 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7403 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7404
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007405 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
7406 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007407
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007408
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007409option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007410 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
7411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7412 yes | yes | yes | yes
7413 Arguments :
7414 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7415 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007416 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007417 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007418
7419 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
7420 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
7421 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
7422 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
7423 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
7424 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
7425 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007426 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
7427 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7428 possible that the client has already brought one.
7429
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007430 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007431 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007432 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007433 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007434 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007435 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007436
7437 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7438 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7439 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7440 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7441 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7442 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7443 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7444
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007445 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
7446 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
7447 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
7448 are under the control of the end-user.
7449
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007450 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007451 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7452 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007453 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
7454 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
7455 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007456
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007457 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007458 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
7459 frontend www
7460 mode http
7461 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
7462
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007463 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
7464 backend www
7465 mode http
7466 option forwardfor header X-Client
7467
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007468 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007469 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007470
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007471
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02007472option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7473no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7474 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
7475 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7476 yes | yes | yes | no
7477 Arguments : none
7478
7479 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7480 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7481 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7482 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7483 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7484 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7485 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7486
7487 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
7488 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
7489 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
7490 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7491 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
7492 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7493 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7494 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
7495 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7496 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7497
7498 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
7499
7500 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7501 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7502
7503 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
7504 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7505
7506
7507option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7508no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7509 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
7510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7511 yes | no | yes | yes
7512 Arguments : none
7513
7514 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7515 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7516 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7517 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7518 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7519 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7520 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7521
7522 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
7523 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
7524 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
7525 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7526 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
7527 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7528 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7529 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
7530 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7531 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7532
7533 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
7534
7535 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7536 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7537
7538 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
7539 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7540
7541
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007542option http-buffer-request
7543no option http-buffer-request
7544 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
7545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7546 yes | yes | yes | yes
7547 Arguments : none
7548
7549 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
7550 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
7551 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
7552 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
7553 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
7554 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01007555 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
7556 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
7557 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
7558 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007559
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01007560 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007561
7562
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007563option http-ignore-probes
7564no option http-ignore-probes
7565 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
7566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7567 yes | yes | yes | no
7568 Arguments : none
7569
7570 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
7571 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
7572 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
7573 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
7574 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
7575 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
7576 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
7577 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
7578 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007579 was received over a connection before it was closed;
7580 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007581 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
7582
7583 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
7584 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
7585 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
7586 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
7587 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
7588 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
7589 are often the only way to detect them.
7590
7591 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7592 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7593
7594 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
7595
7596
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007597option http-keep-alive
7598no option http-keep-alive
7599 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
7600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7601 yes | yes | yes | yes
7602 Arguments : none
7603
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007604 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7605 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007606 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7607 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007608 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
7609 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
7610 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007611
7612 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
7613 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007614 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
7615 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
7616 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
7617 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
7618 situations where this option may be useful :
7619
7620 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007621 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007622
7623 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
7624 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
7625
7626 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
7627 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
7628 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
7629 request.
7630
7631 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
7632 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007633 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
7634 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
7635 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007636
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007637 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7638 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7639 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7640 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
7641 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7642 not set.
7643
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007644 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7645 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
7646 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007647
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007648 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007649 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01007650 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007651
7652
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007653option http-no-delay
7654no option http-no-delay
7655 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
7656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7657 yes | yes | yes | yes
7658 Arguments : none
7659
7660 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
7661 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
7662 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
7663 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
7664 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
7665 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
7666 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
7667 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
7668 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
7669 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
7670 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
7671 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
7672 affected.
7673
7674 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
7675 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
7676 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
7677 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
7678 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
7679 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
7680 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
7681 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
7682 latency environments.
7683
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007684 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7685
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007686
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007687option http-pretend-keepalive
7688no option http-pretend-keepalive
7689 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
7690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007691 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007692 Arguments : none
7693
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007694 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007695 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
7696 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
7697 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
7698 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
7699 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
7700 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
7701 consider the response complete.
7702
7703 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
7704 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
7705 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
7706 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007707 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007708 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
7709
7710 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
7711 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
7712 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
7713 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
7714 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
7715 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
7716 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
7717
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007718 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
7719 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
7720 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
7721 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
7722 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
7723 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007724
7725 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7726 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7727
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007728 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007729 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007730
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007731
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007732option http-server-close
7733no option http-server-close
7734 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
7735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7736 yes | yes | yes | yes
7737 Arguments : none
7738
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007739 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7740 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7741 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7742 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007743 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
7744 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
7745 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
7746 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
7747 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
7748 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
7749 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
7750 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
7751 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
7752 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
7753 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007754
7755 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7756 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7757 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7758 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007759 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7760 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007761
7762 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7763 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007764 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7765 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7766 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007767
7768 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7769 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7770
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007771 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
7772 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007773
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007774option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007775no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007776 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
7777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7778 yes | yes | yes | no
7779 Arguments : none
7780
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00007781 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007782 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
7783 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
7784 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
7785 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
7786 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
7787 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
7788
7789 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
7790 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007791 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
7792 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
7793 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007794
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01007795 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
7796 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
7797 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
7798 front of an existing proxy.
7799
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007800 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
7801
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007802 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007803
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007804option httpchk
7805option httpchk <uri>
7806option httpchk <method> <uri>
7807option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007808 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7810 yes | no | yes | yes
7811 Arguments :
7812 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
7813 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
7814 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
7815 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
7816 ones.
7817
7818 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
7819 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
7820 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
7821
7822 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
7823 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
7824 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007825 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007826
7827 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
7828 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
7829 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
7830 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
7831 the lack of any response.
7832
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007833 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
7834 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
7835 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
7836 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
7837
7838 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
7839 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
7840 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007841
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007842 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
7843 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02007844 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007845 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02007846 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007847
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007848 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
7849 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
7850 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
7851 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
7852
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007853 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007854 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
7855 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
7856 backend https_relay
7857 mode tcp
7858 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
7859 http-check send hdr Host www
7860 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007861
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09007862 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
7863 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
7864 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007865
7866
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007867option httpclose
7868no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007869 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7871 yes | yes | yes | yes
7872 Arguments : none
7873
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007874 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7875 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7876 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7877 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007878 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007879
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007880 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
7881 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05007882 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007883 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
7884 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007885
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007886 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
7887 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
7888 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007889
7890 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7891 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007892 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
7893 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7894 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007895
7896 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7897 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7898
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007899 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007900
7901
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007902option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007903 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
7904 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007905 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007906 Arguments :
7907 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
7908 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
7909 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007910 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007911 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007912
7913 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7914 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7915 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
7916 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
7917 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
7918 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
7919 ports.
7920
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01007921 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
7922 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007923
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007924 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7925
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007926 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007927
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007928
7929option http_proxy
7930no option http_proxy
7931 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
7932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7933 yes | yes | yes | yes
7934 Arguments : none
7935
7936 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
7937 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
7938 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
7939 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
7940 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
7941
7942 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
7943 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007944 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
7945 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007946
7947 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7948 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7949
7950 Example :
7951 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
7952 backend direct_forward
7953 option httpclose
7954 option http_proxy
7955
7956 See also : "option httpclose"
7957
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007958
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007959option independent-streams
7960no option independent-streams
7961 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7963 yes | yes | yes | yes
7964 Arguments : none
7965
7966 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
7967 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
7968 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
7969 receive data or not.
7970
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007971 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007972 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
7973 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
7974 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
7975 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
7976 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
7977 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
7978 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
7979 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
7980 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
7981 socket buffers.
7982
7983 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
7984 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
7985 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
7986 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
7987 slow lines, so use it with caution.
7988
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007989 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007990
7991
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02007992option ldap-check
7993 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
7994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7995 yes | no | yes | yes
7996 Arguments : none
7997
7998 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
7999 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8000 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8001 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8002
8003 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8004 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8005
8006 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8007 configure it.
8008
8009 Example :
8010 option ldap-check
8011
8012 See also : "option httpchk"
8013
8014
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008015option external-check
8016 Use external processes for server health checks
8017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8018 yes | no | yes | yes
8019
8020 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8021 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8022 command".
8023
8024 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8025
8026 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8027
8028
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008029option log-health-checks
8030no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008031 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8033 yes | no | yes | yes
8034 Arguments : none
8035
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008036 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8037 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8038 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008039
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008040 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8041 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8042 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8043 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8044 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8045
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008046 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008047 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008048
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008049 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8050 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8051 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008052
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008053
8054option log-separate-errors
8055no option log-separate-errors
8056 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8058 yes | yes | yes | no
8059 Arguments : none
8060
8061 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
8062 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8063 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8064 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8065 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8066 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8067 provides very important information.
8068
8069 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8070 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8071 error logs.
8072
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008073 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008074 logging.
8075
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008076
8077option logasap
8078no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008079 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008080 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8081 yes | yes | yes | no
8082 Arguments : none
8083
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008084 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
8085 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
8086 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
8087 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
8088
8089 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
8090 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
8091 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
8092 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
8093 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008094 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008095 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
8096 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
8097 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
8098 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008099 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008100
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008101 Examples :
8102 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
8103 mode http
8104 option httplog
8105 option logasap
8106 log 192.168.2.200 local3
8107
8108 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8109 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8110 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
8111 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8112
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008113 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008114 logging.
8115
8116
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008117option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008118 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8120 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008121 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008122 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
8123 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008124 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
8125 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008126
8127 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
8128 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008129 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008130 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
8131 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
8132 in the MySQL table, like this :
8133
8134 USE mysql;
8135 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
8136 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
8137
8138 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008139 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008140 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
8141 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
8142 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
8143 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
8144 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
8145 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
8146 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
8147
8148 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
8149 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008150
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02008151 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008152
8153 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
8154 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
8155 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8156 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008157 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
8158 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008159
8160 See also: "option httpchk"
8161
8162
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008163option nolinger
8164no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008165 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008166 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8167 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008168 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008169
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008170 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008171 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
8172 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
8173 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
8174 connections.
8175
8176 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
8177 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
8178 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
8179 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
8180 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
8181 this too.
8182
8183 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
8184 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
8185 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
8186
8187 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
8188 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
8189 for servers.
8190
8191 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8192 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8193
8194
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008195option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
8196 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
8197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8198 yes | yes | yes | yes
8199 Arguments :
8200 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8201 matching <network>
8202 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
8203 header name.
8204
8205 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
8206 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
8207 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
8208 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
8209 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
8210 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
8211 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
8212 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
8213 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8214 possible that the client has already brought one.
8215
8216 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
8217 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
8218 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
8219 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
8220 header and requires different one.
8221
8222 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8223 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8224 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8225 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8226 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8227 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
8228 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
8229
8230 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
8231 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8232 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
8233 both are defined.
8234
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008235 Examples :
8236 # Original Destination address
8237 frontend www
8238 mode http
8239 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
8240
8241 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
8242 backend www
8243 mode http
8244 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
8245
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008246 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008247
8248
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008249option persist
8250no option persist
8251 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
8252 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8253 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008254 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008255
8256 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
8257 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
8258 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
8259 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
8260 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
8261 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
8262 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
8263 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
8264 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
8265 redirected to another valid server.
8266
8267 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8268 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8269
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01008270 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008271
8272
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01008273option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
8274 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
8275 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8276 yes | no | yes | yes
8277 Arguments :
8278 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
8279 PostgreSQL server.
8280
8281 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
8282 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
8283 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
8284 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
8285
8286 See also: "option httpchk"
8287
8288
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008289option prefer-last-server
8290no option prefer-last-server
8291 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
8292 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8293 yes | no | yes | yes
8294 Arguments : none
8295
8296 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
8297 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
8298 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
8299 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
8300 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
8301 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
8302 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
8303 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
8304 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008305 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
8306 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02008307 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
8308 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
8309 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008310 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
8311 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
8312 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008313
8314 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8315 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8316
8317 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
8318
8319
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008320option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008321option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008322no option redispatch
8323 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8324 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8325 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008326 Arguments :
8327 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
8328 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
8329 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008330 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008331 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008332 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008333 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
8334 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
8335 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
8336
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008337
8338 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8339 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8340 be able to access the service anymore.
8341
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01008342 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
8343 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008344
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02008345 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
8346 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
8347 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
8348 following order:
8349
8350 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
8351
8352 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
8353 list, or
8354
8355 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
8356
8357 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
8358 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
8359
8360 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
8361 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
8362 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
8363 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
8364
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008365 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008366 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8367 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008368
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008369 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8370 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8371
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008372 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008373
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008374
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008375option redis-check
8376 Use redis health checks for server testing
8377 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8378 yes | no | yes | yes
8379 Arguments : none
8380
8381 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
8382 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8383 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
8384 find the "+PONG" response message.
8385
8386 Example :
8387 option redis-check
8388
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008389 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008390
8391
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008392option smtpchk
8393option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
8394 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
8395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8396 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008397 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008398 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02008399 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008400 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
8401
8402 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
8403 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
8404 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
8405
8406 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
8407 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
8408 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
8409 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
8410 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
8411 dead server.
8412
8413 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
8414 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008415 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008416 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
8417
8418 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
8419 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
8420 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8421 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008422 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008423
8424 Example :
8425 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
8426
8427 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
8428
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008429
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008430option socket-stats
8431no option socket-stats
8432
8433 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
8434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8435 yes | yes | yes | no
8436
8437 Arguments : none
8438
8439
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008440option splice-auto
8441no option splice-auto
8442 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
8443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8444 yes | yes | yes | yes
8445 Arguments : none
8446
8447 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
8448 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008449 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008450 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008451 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008452 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
8453 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
8454 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
8455 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8456
8457 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
8458 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
8459 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
8460 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
8461 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
8462 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
8463 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
8464 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
8465 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
8466 keyword.
8467
8468 Example :
8469 option splice-auto
8470
8471 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8472 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8473
8474 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
8475 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8476
8477
8478option splice-request
8479no option splice-request
8480 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
8481 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8482 yes | yes | yes | yes
8483 Arguments : none
8484
8485 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008486 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008487 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8488 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8489 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8490 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8491
8492 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8493
8494 Example :
8495 option splice-request
8496
8497 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8498 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8499
8500 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
8501 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8502
8503
8504option splice-response
8505no option splice-response
8506 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
8507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8508 yes | yes | yes | yes
8509 Arguments : none
8510
8511 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008512 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008513 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8514 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8515 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8516 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8517
8518 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8519
8520 Example :
8521 option splice-response
8522
8523 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8524 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8525
8526 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
8527 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8528
8529
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01008530option spop-check
8531 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
8532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8533 no | no | no | yes
8534 Arguments : none
8535
8536 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
8537 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8538 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
8539 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
8540
8541 Example :
8542 option spop-check
8543
8544 See also : "option httpchk"
8545
8546
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008547option srvtcpka
8548no option srvtcpka
8549 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
8550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8551 yes | no | yes | yes
8552 Arguments : none
8553
8554 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8555 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008556 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008557 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8558
8559 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8560 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8561 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8562 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8563
8564 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8565 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8566 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8567 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8568 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8569
8570 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8571
8572 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8573 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8574 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
8575
8576 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8577 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8578
8579 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
8580
8581
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008582option ssl-hello-chk
8583 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
8584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8585 yes | no | yes | yes
8586 Arguments : none
8587
8588 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
8589 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
8590 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
8591 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
8592 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
8593 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
8594 hello message.
8595
8596 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
8597 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
8598 messages, which is appreciable.
8599
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008600 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
8601 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
8602 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008603
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008604 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
8605
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008606
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008607option tcp-check
8608 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
8609 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8610 yes | no | yes | yes
8611
8612 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
8613 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
8614
8615 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
8616 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
8617 attempt, which remains the default mode.
8618
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008619 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008620 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
8621 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
8622 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
8623 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
8624 only.
8625
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008626 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008627 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
8628 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
8629 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
8630 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
8631
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008632 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008633 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
8634 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008635 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008636 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
8637 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
8638 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
8639 the respective protocols.
8640 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008641 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008642
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008643 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008644
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008645 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
8646 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
8647 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
8648 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008649
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008650 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
8651 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
8652 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01008653
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008654
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008655 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008656 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008657 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008658 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008659
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008660 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008661 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008662 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008663
8664 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
8665 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008666 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008667 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008668 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008669 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008670 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008671 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008672 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8673 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008674 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008675 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8676 tcp-check expect string +OK
8677
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008678 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008679 (send many headers before analyzing)
8680 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008681 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008682 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
8683 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
8684 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
8685 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008686 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008687
8688
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008689 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008690
8691
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008692option tcp-smart-accept
8693no option tcp-smart-accept
8694 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
8695 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8696 yes | yes | yes | no
8697 Arguments : none
8698
8699 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
8700 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
8701 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
8702 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
8703 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
8704 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
8705
8706 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
8707 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
8708 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
8709 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
8710
8711 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
8712 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
8713 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008714 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008715
8716 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
8717 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
8718 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
8719
8720 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
8721 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
8722 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
8723
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02008724 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
8725
8726
8727option tcp-smart-connect
8728no option tcp-smart-connect
8729 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
8730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8731 yes | no | yes | yes
8732 Arguments : none
8733
8734 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
8735 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
8736 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
8737 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
8738 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
8739
8740 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
8741 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
8742 complex.
8743
8744 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
8745 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
8746 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
8747
8748 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8749 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8750
8751 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
8752
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008753
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008754option tcpka
8755 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
8756 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8757 yes | yes | yes | yes
8758 Arguments : none
8759
8760 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8761 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008762 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008763 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8764
8765 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8766 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8767 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8768 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8769
8770 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8771 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8772 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8773 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8774 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8775
8776 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8777
8778 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
8779 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
8780 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
8781 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
8782 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
8783 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
8784 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
8785 backends.
8786
8787 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
8788
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008789
8790option tcplog
8791 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
8792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008793 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008794 Arguments : none
8795
8796 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8797 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8798 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
8799 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
8800 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
8801 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
8802 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
8803 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
8804
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008805 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8806
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008807 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008808
8809
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008810option transparent
8811no option transparent
8812 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008814 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008815 Arguments : none
8816
8817 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
8818 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8819 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8820 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8821 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8822 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8823 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8824 appropriate server.
8825
8826 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8827 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8828
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01008829 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008830 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008831
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008832
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008833external-check command <command>
8834 Executable to run when performing an external-check
8835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8836 yes | no | yes | yes
8837
8838 Arguments :
8839 <command> is the external command to run
8840
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008841 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
8842
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008843 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008844
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008845 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
8846 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
8847 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
8848 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
8849 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
8850 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008851
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01008852 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
8853
8854 Environment variables :
8855 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
8856 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
8857
8858 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
8859
8860 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
8861
8862 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
8863 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
8864 for a UNIX socket).
8865
8866 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
8867
8868 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
8869
8870 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
8871
8872 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
8873
8874 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
8875
8876 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
8877 socket).
8878
8879 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
8880 the command may be set using "external-check path".
8881
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02008882 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
8883
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008884 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
8885 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
8886 failed.
8887
8888 Example :
8889 external-check command /bin/true
8890
8891 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
8892
8893
8894external-check path <path>
8895 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
8896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8897 yes | no | yes | yes
8898
8899 Arguments :
8900 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
8901
8902 The default path is "".
8903
8904 Example :
8905 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
8906
8907 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
8908 "external-check command"
8909
8910
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008911persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008912persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008913 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
8914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8915 yes | no | yes | yes
8916 Arguments :
8917 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008918 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
8919 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008920
8921 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
8922 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008923 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008924 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
8925 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
8926 forwarded to this server.
8927
8928 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
8929 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
8930 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008931 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008932 a single "listen" section.
8933
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008934 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
8935 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
8936 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
8937
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008938 Example :
8939 listen tse-farm
8940 bind :3389
8941 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8942 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8943 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8944 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8945 persist rdp-cookie
8946 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008947 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008948 balance rdp-cookie
8949 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8950 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
8951
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008952 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
8953 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008954
8955
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008956rate-limit sessions <rate>
8957 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
8958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8959 yes | yes | yes | no
8960 Arguments :
8961 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
8962 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
8963
8964 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
8965 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
8966 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
8967 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
8968 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
8969 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
8970
8971 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
8972 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
8973 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
8974 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
8975
8976 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
8977 listen smtp
8978 mode tcp
8979 bind :25
8980 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02008981 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008982
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02008983 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
8984 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
8985 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008986
8987 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
8988
8989
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008990redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8991redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8992redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008993 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
8994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8995 no | yes | yes | yes
8996
8997 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01008998 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008999
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009000 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009001 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009002 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9003 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9004 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009005
9006 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9007 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9008 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9009 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9010 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009011 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9012 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9013 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9014 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009015
9016 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9017 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9018 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9019 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9020 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9021 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009022 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009023 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009024 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9025 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9026 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009027
9028 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009029 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9030 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9031 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009032 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009033 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9034 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9035 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9036 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009037
9038 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009039 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009040
9041 - "drop-query"
9042 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9043 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9044 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9045 with a location-type redirect.
9046
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009047 - "append-slash"
9048 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
9049 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
9050 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
9051 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
9052
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009053 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
9054 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
9055 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
9056 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
9057 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
9058 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
9059 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
9060
9061 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
9062 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
9063 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
9064 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
9065 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
9066 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
9067 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009068
9069 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
9070 acl clear dst_port 80
9071 acl secure dst_port 8080
9072 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009073 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009074 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009075 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
9076
9077 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009078 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
9079 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
9080 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009081 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009082
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009083 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
9084 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
9085 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
9086
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009087 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01009088 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009089
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009090 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02009091 http-request redirect code 301 location \
9092 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
9093 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009094
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009095 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009096
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01009097
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009098retries <value>
9099 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
9100 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9101 yes | no | yes | yes
9102 Arguments :
9103 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
9104 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
9105 default value is 3.
9106
9107 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
9108 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
9109 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
9110
9111 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009112 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
9113 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009114
9115 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
9116 server even if a cookie references a different server.
9117
9118 See also : "option redispatch"
9119
9120
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009121retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02009122 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
9123 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
9124 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009125 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9126 yes | no | yes | yes
9127 Arguments :
9128 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
9129 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
9130 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
9131 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
9132
9133 none never retry
9134
9135 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
9136 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
9137
9138 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
9139 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
9140 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
9141 request timeout on the server side, poor network
9142 condition, or a server crash or restart while
9143 processing the request.
9144
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02009145 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
9146 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
9147 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
9148 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
9149 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
9150 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
9151 overflow attack for example).
9152
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009153 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
9154 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
9155 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
9156 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
9157 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
9158 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
9159 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
9160 amplify denial of service attacks.
9161
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02009162 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
9163 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
9164 considered to be safe to retry.
9165
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009166 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
9167 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
9168 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
9169 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
9170
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02009171 all-retryable-errors
9172 retry request for any error that are considered
9173 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
9174 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
9175 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
9176
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009177 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
9178 not cumulative.
9179
9180 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
9181 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
9182 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
9183 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
9184
9185 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
9186 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
9187 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
9188 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
9189 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
9190 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
9191 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
9192 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
9193 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
9194 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
9195 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
9196 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
9197
9198 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
9199 should not use this directive.
9200
9201 The default is "conn-failure".
9202
9203 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
9204
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009205server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009206 Declare a server in a backend
9207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9208 no | no | yes | yes
9209 Arguments :
9210 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009211 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009212 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009213
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009214 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
9215 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
9216 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
9217 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02009218 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
9219 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
9220 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
9221 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
9222 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009223 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
9224 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
9225 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
9226 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
9227 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9228 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9229 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009230 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02009231 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
9232 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
9233 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
9234 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
9235 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
9236 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009237 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9238 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01009239 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
9240 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009241
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009242 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009243 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
9244 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
9245 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
9246 adding this value to the client's port.
9247
9248 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
9249 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009250 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009251
9252 Examples :
9253 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
9254 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009255 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009256 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
9257 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
9258 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009259
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02009260 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
9261 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
9262 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
9263 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
9264 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
9265
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009266 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
9267 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009268
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009269server-state-file-name [<file>]
9270 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
9271 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
9272 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
9273 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
9274 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
9275 global directive "server-state-file-base".
9276
9277 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
9278 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
9279
9280 global
9281 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
9282
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01009283 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009284 load-server-state-from-file
9285
9286 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
9287 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009288
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02009289server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
9290 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
9291 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
9292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9293 no | no | yes | yes
9294
9295 Arguments:
9296 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
9297
9298 <num | range>
9299 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
9300 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
9301 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
9302 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
9303
9304 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
9305
9306 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
9307
9308 <params*>
9309 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
9310 keyword.
9311
9312 Examples:
9313 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
9314 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
9315 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
9316
9317 # or
9318 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
9319
9320 # would be equivalent to:
9321 server srv1 google.com:80 check
9322 server srv2 google.com:80 check
9323 server srv3 google.com:80 check
9324
9325
9326
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009327source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009328source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009329source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009330 Set the source address for outgoing connections
9331 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9332 yes | no | yes | yes
9333 Arguments :
9334 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
9335 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009336
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009337 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009338 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
9339 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
9340 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
9341 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
9342 supported prefixes are :
9343 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9344 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9345 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009346 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02009347 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9348 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009349
9350 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
9351 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009352 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
9353 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
9354 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009355
9356 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
9357 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
9358 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
9359 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
9360 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
9361 <addr>.
9362
9363 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
9364 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
9365 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
9366 port.
9367
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009368 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
9369 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
9370 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
9371 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009372 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009373 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
9374 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
9375 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
9376 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
9377 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
9378 HTTP header.
9379
9380 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
9381 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009382 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009383 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
9384 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
9385 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
9386 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
9387 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
9388 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
9389 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
9390
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009391 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
9392 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
9393 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
9394 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
9395 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
9396 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
9397
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009398 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
9399 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
9400 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
9401 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
9402
9403 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
9404 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
9405 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
9406 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
9407 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
9408 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
9409
9410 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
9411 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
9412 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
9413 there are two methods :
9414
9415 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
9416 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
9417 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
9418 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
9419 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
9420 of the client ranges may be used.
9421
9422 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
9423 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
9424 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
9425 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
9426 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
9427 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
9428 same session.
9429
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009430 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
9431 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
9432 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009433 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009434
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02009435 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
9436
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009437 Examples :
9438 backend private
9439 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
9440 source 192.168.1.200
9441
9442 backend transparent_ssl1
9443 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
9444 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9445
9446 backend transparent_ssl2
9447 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
9448 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
9449 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
9450
9451 backend transparent_ssl3
9452 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
9453 # is more conntrack-friendly.
9454 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9455
9456 backend transparent_smtp
9457 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
9458 # with Tproxy version 4.
9459 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
9460
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009461 backend transparent_http
9462 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
9463 # proxy.
9464 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
9465
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009466 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009467 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
9468
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009469
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009470srvtcpka-cnt <count>
9471 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
9472 the connection on the server side.
9473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9474 yes | no | yes | yes
9475 Arguments :
9476 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
9477
9478 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
9479 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009480 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9481 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009482
9483 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9484
9485
9486srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
9487 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
9488 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
9489 server side.
9490 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9491 yes | no | yes | yes
9492 Arguments :
9493 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
9494 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
9495 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
9496 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
9497
9498 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
9499 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009500 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9501 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009502
9503 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9504
9505
9506srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
9507 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
9508 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9509 yes | no | yes | yes
9510 Arguments :
9511 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
9512 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
9513 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
9514 document.
9515
9516 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
9517 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009518 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9519 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009520
9521 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
9522
9523
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009524stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
9525 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
9526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009527 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009528
9529 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
9530 matched.
9531
9532 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
9533 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
9534
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009535 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9536 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009537 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009538
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01009539 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
9540 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
9541 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
9542 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009543
9544 Example :
9545 # statistics admin level only for localhost
9546 backend stats_localhost
9547 stats enable
9548 stats admin if LOCALHOST
9549
9550 Example :
9551 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
9552 backend stats_auth
9553 stats enable
9554 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
9555 stats admin if TRUE
9556
9557 Example :
9558 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
9559 userlist stats-auth
9560 group admin users admin
9561 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
9562 group readonly users haproxy
9563 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
9564
9565 backend stats_auth
9566 stats enable
9567 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
9568 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
9569 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
9570 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
9571
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009572 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
9573 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
9574 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009575
9576
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009577stats auth <user>:<passwd>
9578 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
9579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009580 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009581 Arguments :
9582 <user> is a user name to grant access to
9583
9584 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
9585
9586 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
9587 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
9588 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
9589 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
9590 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
9591 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
9592
9593 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
9594 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
9595 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009596 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009597
9598 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
9599 report using "stats scope".
9600
9601 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9602 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9603 unobvious parameters.
9604
9605 Example :
9606 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9607 backend public_www
9608 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9609 stats enable
9610 stats hide-version
9611 stats scope .
9612 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009613 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009614 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9615 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9616
9617 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9618 backend private_monitoring
9619 stats enable
9620 stats uri /admin?stats
9621 stats refresh 5s
9622
9623 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
9624
9625
9626stats enable
9627 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
9628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009629 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009630 Arguments : none
9631
9632 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
9633 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
9634 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
9635 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
9636 - stats auth : no authentication
9637 - stats scope : no restriction
9638
9639 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9640 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9641 unobvious parameters.
9642
9643 Example :
9644 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9645 backend public_www
9646 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9647 stats enable
9648 stats hide-version
9649 stats scope .
9650 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009651 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009652 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9653 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9654
9655 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9656 backend private_monitoring
9657 stats enable
9658 stats uri /admin?stats
9659 stats refresh 5s
9660
9661 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9662
9663
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009664stats hide-version
9665 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009667 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009668 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009669
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009670 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
9671 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
9672 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
9673 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
9674 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
9675 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009676
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009677 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9678 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9679 unobvious parameters.
9680
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009681 Example :
9682 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9683 backend public_www
9684 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009685 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009686 stats hide-version
9687 stats scope .
9688 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009689 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009690 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9691 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009692
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009693 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9694 backend private_monitoring
9695 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009696 stats uri /admin?stats
9697 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01009698
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009699 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009700
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009701
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02009702stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
9703 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
9704 Access control for statistics
9705
9706 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9707 no | no | yes | yes
9708
9709 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
9710 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
9711 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
9712 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
9713 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
9714 should be asked to enter a username and password.
9715
9716 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
9717 instance.
9718
9719 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
9720 about ACL usage.
9721
9722
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009723stats realm <realm>
9724 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
9725 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009726 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009727 Arguments :
9728 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
9729 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
9730 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
9731
9732 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
9733 using a backslash ('\').
9734
9735 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
9736 only related to authentication.
9737
9738 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9739 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9740 unobvious parameters.
9741
9742 Example :
9743 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9744 backend public_www
9745 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9746 stats enable
9747 stats hide-version
9748 stats scope .
9749 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009750 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009751 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9752 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9753
9754 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9755 backend private_monitoring
9756 stats enable
9757 stats uri /admin?stats
9758 stats refresh 5s
9759
9760 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9761
9762
9763stats refresh <delay>
9764 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009766 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009767 Arguments :
9768 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9769 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9770 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9771 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9772 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9773 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9774
9775 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9776 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9777 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
9778 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
9779
9780 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9781 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9782 unobvious parameters.
9783
9784 Example :
9785 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9786 backend public_www
9787 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9788 stats enable
9789 stats hide-version
9790 stats scope .
9791 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009792 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009793 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9794 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9795
9796 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9797 backend private_monitoring
9798 stats enable
9799 stats uri /admin?stats
9800 stats refresh 5s
9801
9802 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9803
9804
9805stats scope { <name> | "." }
9806 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009808 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009809 Arguments :
9810 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9811 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9812 section in which the statement appears.
9813
9814 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9815 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9816 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9817 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9818 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9819 exists.
9820
9821 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9822 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9823 unobvious parameters.
9824
9825 Example :
9826 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9827 backend public_www
9828 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9829 stats enable
9830 stats hide-version
9831 stats scope .
9832 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009833 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009834 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9835 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9836
9837 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9838 backend private_monitoring
9839 stats enable
9840 stats uri /admin?stats
9841 stats refresh 5s
9842
9843 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9844
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009845
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009846stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009847 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009849 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009850
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009851 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009852 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9853
9854 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9855 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9856
9857 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9858 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009859 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009860
9861 Example :
9862 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9863 backend private_monitoring
9864 stats enable
9865 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9866 stats uri /admin?stats
9867 stats refresh 5s
9868
9869 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9870 global section.
9871
9872
9873stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009874 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9876 yes | yes | yes | yes
9877 Arguments : none
9878
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009879 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009880 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9881 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9882 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9883 - IP (socket, server)
9884 - cookie (backend, server)
9885
9886 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9887 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009888 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009889
9890 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
9891
9892
9893stats show-node [ <name> ]
9894 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009896 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009897 Arguments:
9898 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9899 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9900
9901 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9902 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009903 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009904
9905 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9906 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9907 unobvious parameters.
9908
9909 Example:
9910 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9911 backend private_monitoring
9912 stats enable
9913 stats show-node Europe-1
9914 stats uri /admin?stats
9915 stats refresh 5s
9916
9917 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
9918 section.
9919
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009920
9921stats uri <prefix>
9922 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9923 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009924 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009925 Arguments :
9926 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9927 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9928 query string.
9929
9930 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9931 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9932 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9933 possible to reach it in the application.
9934
9935 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009936 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009937 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9938 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9939 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9940 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9941
9942 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9943 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9944 an address or a port to statistics only.
9945
9946 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9947 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9948 unobvious parameters.
9949
9950 Example :
9951 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9952 backend public_www
9953 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9954 stats enable
9955 stats hide-version
9956 stats scope .
9957 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009958 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009959 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9960 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9961
9962 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9963 backend private_monitoring
9964 stats enable
9965 stats uri /admin?stats
9966 stats refresh 5s
9967
9968 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9969
9970
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009971stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9972 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009974 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009975
9976 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009977 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009978 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009979 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009980 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9981
9982 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9983 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9984 the "stick-table" statement.
9985
9986 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9987 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9988 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9989 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9990 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9991
9992 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9993 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9994 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9995 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9996 transformation rules.
9997
9998 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9999 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10000 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10001 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10002 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10003 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10004 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10005
10006 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10007 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10008 ACL based conditions.
10009
10010 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10011 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10012 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10013 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10014
10015 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10016 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10017 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10018 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10019
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010020 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10021 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010022 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010023
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010024 Example :
10025 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10026 # last 30 minutes
10027 backend pop
10028 mode tcp
10029 balance roundrobin
10030 stick store-request src
10031 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10032 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10033 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10034
10035 backend smtp
10036 mode tcp
10037 balance roundrobin
10038 stick match src table pop
10039 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10040 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10041
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010042 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010043 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010044
10045
10046stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10047 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
10048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10049 no | no | yes | yes
10050
10051 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
10052 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
10053 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
10054 for writing more maintainable configurations.
10055
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010056 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10057 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010058 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010059
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010060 Examples :
10061 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010010062 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010063
10064 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
10065 stick match src table pop if !localhost
10066 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
10067
10068
10069 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
10070 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
10071 backend http
10072 mode http
10073 balance roundrobin
10074 stick on src table https
10075 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
10076 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
10077 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
10078
10079 backend https
10080 mode tcp
10081 balance roundrobin
10082 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10083 stick on src
10084 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10085 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10086
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010087 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010088
10089
10090stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10091 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
10092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10093 no | no | yes | yes
10094
10095 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010096 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010097 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010098 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010099 server is selected.
10100
10101 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10102 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10103 the "stick-table" statement.
10104
10105 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10106 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10107 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
10108 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
10109 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
10110 address.
10111
10112 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10113 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
10114 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
10115 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
10116 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
10117 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
10118 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
10119 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
10120 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
10121 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
10122
10123 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10124 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10125 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10126 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10127 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10128 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10129 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10130
10131 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
10132 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10133 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
10134 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10135
10136 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
10137 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10138 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10139 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10140 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10141 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010142 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
10143 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10144 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10145 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10146 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10147 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010148
10149 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
10150 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
10151 the request.
10152
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010153 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10154 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010155 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010156
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010157 Example :
10158 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10159 # last 30 minutes
10160 backend pop
10161 mode tcp
10162 balance roundrobin
10163 stick store-request src
10164 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10165 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10166 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10167
10168 backend smtp
10169 mode tcp
10170 balance roundrobin
10171 stick match src table pop
10172 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10173 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10174
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010175 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010176 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010177
10178
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010179stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010180 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
10181 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080010182 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010184 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010185
10186 Arguments :
10187 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
10188 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
10189 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10190 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10191
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010010192 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
10193 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
10194 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10195 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10196
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010197 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
10198 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
10199 instance.
10200
10201 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
10202 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
10203 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
10204 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
10205 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
10206 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010207 to 32 characters.
10208
10209 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
10210 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
10211 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010212 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010213 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
10214 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010215
10216 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010217 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
10218 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010219 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
10220 increase.
10221
10222 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010223 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
10224 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
10225 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010226
10227 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
10228 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
10229 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
10230 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010231 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010232 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
10233 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
10234 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
10235 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
10236 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
10237 parameter (see below).
10238
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010239 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
10240 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
10241 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
10242 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
10243 soft restart.
10244
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020010245 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
10246 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010247
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010248 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
10249 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
10250 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
10251 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010252 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010253 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010254 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
10255 if not expiration delay is specified.
10256
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010257 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
10258 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
10259 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
10260 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010261 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
10262 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
10263 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
10264 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
10265 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
10266 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
10267 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
10268 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
10269 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
10270 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
10271 types and their arguments.
10272
10273 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
10274 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
10275 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
10276 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
10277
10278 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10279 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10280 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010281 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010282
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010283 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10284 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10285 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010286 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010287 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010288 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010289
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010290 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10291 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10292 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
10293 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
10294
10295 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
10296 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10297 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
10298 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
10299 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
10300 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
10301
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010302 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10303 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
10304 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
10305 they were received.
10306
10307 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10308 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
10309 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
10310 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
10311 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
10312
10313 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10314 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10315 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10316 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
10317 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10318
10319 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10320 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
10321 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
10322
10323 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10324 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10325 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10326 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
10327 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10328
10329 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10330 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
10331 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
10332 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
10333 the client side.
10334
10335 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10336 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10337 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10338 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
10339 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
10340 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
10341 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
10342
10343 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10344 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
10345 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
10346 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
10347 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
10348 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010349 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010350
10351 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10352 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10353 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10354 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
10355 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
10356 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10357
10358 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010359 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010360 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
10361 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
10362
10363 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10364 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10365 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10366 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10367 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10368 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
10369 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
10370 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
10371 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
10372 recommended for better fairness.
10373
10374 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010375 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010376 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
10377 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
10378
10379 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
10380 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10381 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10382 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10383 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10384 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
10385 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
10386 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
10387 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
10388 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010389
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010390 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
10391 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010392 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
10393 reference it.
10394
10395 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
10396 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010010397 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
10398 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
10399 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010400
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010401 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
10402 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
10403 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
10404 something that can be ignored.
10405
10406 Example:
10407 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
10408 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
10409 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
10410 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
10411
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010412 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010010413 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010414
10415
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010416stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010010417 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10419 no | no | yes | yes
10420
10421 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010422 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010423 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010424 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010425 server is selected.
10426
10427 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10428 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10429 the "stick-table" statement.
10430
10431 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10432 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10433 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
10434 when the response is a SSL server hello.
10435
10436 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10437 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
10438 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
10439 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
10440 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
10441 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010442 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010443 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
10444 rules.
10445
10446 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10447 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10448 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10449 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10450 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10451 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10452 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10453
10454 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
10455 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10456 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
10457 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10458
10459 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
10460 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10461 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10462 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10463 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10464 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010465 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
10466 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10467 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10468 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10469 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10470 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
10471 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
10472 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
10473 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010474
10475 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
10476
10477 Example :
10478 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
10479 backend https
10480 mode tcp
10481 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010482 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010483 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010484
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010485 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
10486 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
10487
10488 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
10489 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10490 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
10491
10492 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
10493 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010494
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010495 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
10496 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
10497 # at offset 44.
10498
10499 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
10500 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
10501
10502 # Learn on response if server hello.
10503 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010504
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010505 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10506 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10507
10508 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
10509 extraction.
10510
10511
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010512tcp-check comment <string>
10513 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
10514 it fails.
10515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10516 yes | no | yes | yes
10517
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010518 Arguments :
10519 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
10520 rule fails.
10521
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010522 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
10523 user-friendly error reporting.
10524
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010525 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
10526 "tcp-check expect".
10527
10528
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010529tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
10530 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010531 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010532 Opens a new connection
10533 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010534 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010535
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010536 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010537 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10538
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010539 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040010540 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010541
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010542 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010543 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
10544 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010545 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010546
10547 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010548
10549 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
10550
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020010551 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
10552
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010553 ssl opens a ciphered connection
10554
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020010555 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
10556
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020010557 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
10558 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
10559 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10560 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
10561
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010562 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
10563 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
10564 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
10565 haproxy -vv.
10566
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010567 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010568
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010569 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
10570 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
10571 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
10572
10573 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
10574 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
10575 of the sequence.
10576
10577 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
10578 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
10579 do.
10580
10581 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
10582 unset-var or comment rules.
10583
10584 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010585 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
10586 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
10587 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
10588 option tcp-check
10589 tcp-check connect
10590 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10591 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10592 tcp-check send \r\n
10593 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10594 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
10595 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10596 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10597 tcp-check send \r\n
10598 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10599 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
10600
10601 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
10602 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010603 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010604 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10605 tcp-check connect port 143
10606 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10607 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
10608
10609 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
10610
10611
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010612tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010613 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010614 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010615 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010616 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010617 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010618 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010619
10620 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010621 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10622
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010623 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
10624 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
10625 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
10626 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
10627 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
10628 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
10629 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
10630 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
10631 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
10632 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
10633
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010634 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010635 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
10636 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010637 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
10638 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
10639 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
10640
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010641 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10642 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
10643 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010644 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
10645 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
10646 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
10647 example 404 with disable-on-404
10648 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
10649 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010650 By default "L7OK" is used.
10651
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010652 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10653 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010654 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
10655 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
10656 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
10657 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
10658 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
10659 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010660
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010661 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010662 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010663 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
10664 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
10665 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
10666 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010667 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
10668
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020010669 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10670 informational message reported in logs if the expect
10671 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
10672 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
10673
10674 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10675 informational message reported in logs if an error
10676 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
10677 log-format string.
10678
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010679 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
10680 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
10681 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10682 followed by some converters.
10683
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010684 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
10685 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
10686 with the usual backslash ('\').
10687 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010688 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010689 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
10690 used upper or lower case.
10691
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010692 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
10693
10694 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
10695 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10696 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
10697 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10698 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
10699 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
10700 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
10701 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
10702
10703 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
10704 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10705 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
10706 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10707 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
10708 expression.
10709
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010710 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
10711 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10712 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
10713 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
10714 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10715 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
10716
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010717 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
10718 in the response buffer. A health check response will
10719 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
10720 this exact hexadecimal string.
10721 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
10722
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010723 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
10724 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
10725 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
10726 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
10727 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
10728 size of the original response. As such, the expected
10729 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
10730 size.
10731
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010732 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
10733 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
10734 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
10735 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
10736 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
10737 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10738 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
10739 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
10740 in a binary string before matching the response's
10741 buffer.
10742
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010743 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
10744 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
10745 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
10746 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
10747 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
10748 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
10749 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
10750 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
10751 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
10752 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
10753 the null character.
10754
10755 Examples :
10756 # perform a POP check
10757 option tcp-check
10758 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10759
10760 # perform an IMAP check
10761 option tcp-check
10762 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10763
10764 # look for the redis master server
10765 option tcp-check
10766 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020010767 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010768 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10769 tcp-check expect string role:master
10770 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10771 tcp-check expect string +OK
10772
10773
10774 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
10775 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
10776
10777
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010778tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
10779tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
10780 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
10781 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010782 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010783 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010784
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010785 Arguments :
10786 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10787
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010788 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
10789 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010790
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010791 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
10792 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010793
10794 Examples :
10795 # look for the redis master server
10796 option tcp-check
10797 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10798 tcp-check expect string role:master
10799
10800 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10801 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
10802
10803
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010804tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
10805tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
10806 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
10807 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010808 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010809 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010810
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010811 Arguments :
10812 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010813
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010814 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
10815 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010816
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010817 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
10818 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
10819 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010820
10821 Examples :
10822 # redis check in binary
10823 option tcp-check
10824 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
10825 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
10826
10827
10828 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10829 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
10830
10831
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010832tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010833 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010834 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010835 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010836
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010837 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010838 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10839 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10840 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10841 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10842 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10843 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10844 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10845 and '-'.
10846
10847 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
10848
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010849 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010850 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
10851
10852
10853tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010854 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010855 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010856 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010857
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010858 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010859 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10860 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10861 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10862 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10863 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10864 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10865 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10866 and '-'.
10867
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010868 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010869 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
10870
10871
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010872tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10873 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10875 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010876 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010877 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10878 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010879
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010880 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010881
10882 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
10883 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010884 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
10885 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
10886 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
10887 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
10888 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
10889 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010890
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010891 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10892 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10893 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
10894 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010895
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010896 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010897 - accept :
10898 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10899 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10900 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010901
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010902 - reject :
10903 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10904 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10905 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
10906 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
10907 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
10908 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
10909 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
10910 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
10911 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
10912 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
10913 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010914 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010915
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010916 - expect-proxy layer4 :
10917 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
10918 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
10919 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
10920 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
10921 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
10922 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
10923 hosts.
10924
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010925 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
10926 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
10927 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
10928 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
10929 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
10930 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
10931 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
10932 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
10933
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010934 - capture <sample> len <length> :
10935 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
10936 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
10937 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
10938 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
10939 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
10940 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
10941 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
10942 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010943 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
10944 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010945
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010946 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010947 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010948 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
10949 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
10950 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010951 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010952 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
10953 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
10954 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
10955 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
10956 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
10957 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
10958 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
10959 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010960
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010961 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010962 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010963 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010964 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010965 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
10966 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
10967 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010968
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010969 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
10970 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
10971 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
10972 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010973
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010974 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
10975 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
10976 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
10977 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
10978 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010979 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
10980 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
10981 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
10982 layer7 information is extracted.
10983
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010984 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
10985 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
10986 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
10987 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
10988 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010989
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010990 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10991 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10992 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10993 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10994
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010995 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10996 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10997 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10998 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10999
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011000 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
11001 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11002 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11003 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11004 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011005
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011006 - set-src <expr> :
11007 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
11008 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
11009 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011010 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011011
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011012 Arguments:
11013 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11014 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011015
11016 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011017 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
11018
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011019 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
11020 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011021
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011022 - set-src-port <expr> :
11023 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
11024 expression.
11025
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011026 Arguments:
11027 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11028 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011029
11030 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011031 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
11032
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011033 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
11034 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
11035 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011036
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011037 - set-dst <expr> :
11038 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
11039 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
11040 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
11041 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11042 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11043
11044 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11045 followed by some converters.
11046
11047 Example:
11048
11049 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
11050 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
11051
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011052 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
11053 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
11054
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011055 - set-dst-port <expr> :
11056 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
11057 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11058 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11059
11060
11061 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11062 followed by some converters.
11063
11064 Example:
11065
11066 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
11067
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011068 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
11069 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
11070 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
11071
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011072 - "silent-drop" :
11073 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011074 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011075 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11076 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11077 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11078 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11079 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011080 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11081 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011082 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11083 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011084 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011085 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11086 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11087 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11088 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11089
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011090 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11091 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11092 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011093
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011094 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11095 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
11096 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011097
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011098 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011099 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011100 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011101
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011102 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
11103 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11104 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011105
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011106 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011107 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11108 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011109
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011110 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
11111
11112 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11113
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011114 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11115
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011116 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011117
11118
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011119tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11120 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011121 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011122 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011123 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011124 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11125 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011126
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011127 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011128
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011129 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011130 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11131 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
11132 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
11133 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011134
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011135 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
11136 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
11137 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
11138 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011139 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
11140 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
11141 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
11142 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
11143 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
11144 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011145 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011146 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011147
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011148 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11149 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11150 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11151 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011152
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011153 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011154 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011155 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011156 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11157 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011158 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011159 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011160 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011161 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011162 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011163 - set-dst <expr>
11164 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011165 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011166 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011167 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011168 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011169 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011170
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011171 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
11172 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011173 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
11174 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011175
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011176 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
11177 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
11178 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
11179 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
11180 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
11181 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011182
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011183 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011184 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11185 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011186
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011187 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011188 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
11189 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
11190 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
11191 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011192 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
11193 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
11194 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011195
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011196 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011197 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
11198 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
11199 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011200
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011201 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
11202 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
11203
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011204 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011205 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
11206 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011207
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011208 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11209 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011210 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011211 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11212 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011213 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011214 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011215 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011216 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11217 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011218 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011219 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11220 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011221
11222 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11223 followed by some converters.
11224
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011225 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11226 <var-name>.
11227
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011228 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
11229 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
11230 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
11231 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
11232 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
11233
11234 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
11235 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
11236 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
11237 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
11238 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
11239 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
11240 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
11241 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
11242 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
11243 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
11244 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
11245
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011246 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11247 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11248 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11249 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11250 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11251
11252 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11253
11254 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11255
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011256 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
11257 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
11258 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
11259 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
11260 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
11261 evaluated.
11262
11263 Example:
11264 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
11265
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011266 Example:
11267
11268 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011269 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011270
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011271 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011272 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
11273 # and reject everything else.
11274 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
11275 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011276 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011277 tcp-request content reject
11278
11279 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011280 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
11281 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11282 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011283 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011284
11285 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
11286 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11287 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011288 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011289 tcp-request content reject
11290
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011291 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011292 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011293 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011294 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011295 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
11296 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011297
11298 Example:
11299 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11300 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011301 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011302
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011303 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011304 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011305
11306 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011307 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011308 # protecting all our sites
11309 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011310 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11311 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011312 ...
11313 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
11314
11315 backend http_dynamic
11316 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011317 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011318 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011319 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011320 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011321 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011322 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011323
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011324 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011325
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030011326 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
11327 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011328
11329
11330tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
11331 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
11332 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011333 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011334 Arguments :
11335 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11336 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11337 as explained at the top of this document.
11338
11339 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
11340 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
11341 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
11342 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
11343 data for at most the specified amount of time.
11344
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011345 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
11346 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
11347 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
11348 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
11349
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011350 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
11351 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011352 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011353 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010011354 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
11355 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
11356 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
11357 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011358
11359 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
11360 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
11361 it pass through unaffected.
11362
11363 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
11364 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
11365 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011366 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011367 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
11368 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020011369 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
11370 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
11371 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011372
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011373 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011374 "timeout client".
11375
11376
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011377tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11378 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
11379 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11380 no | no | yes | yes
11381 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011382 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11383 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011384
11385 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11386
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011387 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011388 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11389 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011390 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
11391 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011392
11393 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
11394
11395 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11396 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11397 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11398 inserted.
11399
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011400 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011401 - accept :
11402 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11403 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11404 the rules evaluation.
11405
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011406 - close :
11407 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
11408 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
11409 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
11410 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
11411 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
11412 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011413 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011414 protocols.
11415
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011416 - reject :
11417 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11418 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011419 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011420
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011421 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
11422 Sets a variable.
11423
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011424 - unset-var(<var-name>)
11425 Unsets a variable.
11426
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011427 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11428 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11429 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11430 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11431
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011432 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11433 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11434 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11435 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11436
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011437 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
11438 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11439 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11440 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11441 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011442
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011443 - "silent-drop" :
11444 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011445 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011446 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11447 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11448 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11449 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11450 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011451 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11452 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011453 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11454 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011455 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011456 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11457 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11458 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11459 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11460
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011461 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
11462 Send a group of SPOE messages.
11463
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011464 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11465 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11466 for changing the default action to a reject.
11467
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011468 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
11469 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
11470 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
11471 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011472 period.
11473
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011474 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
11475 declared inline.
11476
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011477 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11478 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011479 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011480 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11481 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011482 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011483 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011484 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011485 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11486 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011487 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011488 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11489 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011490
11491 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11492 followed by some converters.
11493
11494 Example:
11495
11496 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
11497
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011498 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11499 <var-name>.
11500
11501 Example:
11502
11503 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
11504
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011505 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11506 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11507 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11508 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11509 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11510
11511 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11512
11513 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11514
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011515 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11516
11517 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
11518
11519
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011520tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11521 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
11522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11523 no | yes | yes | no
11524 Arguments :
11525 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11526 below.
11527
11528 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11529
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011530 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011531 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
11532 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
11533 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
11534 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
11535 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
11536 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
11537 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011538 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011539 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
11540 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
11541 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
11542 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
11543 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
11544 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
11545 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
11546 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
11547 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
11548 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
11549 instead.
11550
11551 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11552 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11553 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
11554 rules which may be inserted.
11555
11556 Several types of actions are supported :
11557 - accept : the request is accepted
11558 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11559 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
11560 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011561 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011562 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011563 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011564 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011565 - silent-drop
11566
11567 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
11568 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
11569 sections for a complete description.
11570
11571 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11572 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11573 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
11574
11575 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
11576 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
11577 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
11578 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
11579 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
11580
11581 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11582 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11583
11584 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11585 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
11586 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
11587
11588 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11589 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
11590 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11591
11592 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
11593 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11594 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
11595
11596 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11597 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11598 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
11599
11600 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11601
11602 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
11603
11604
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011605tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
11606 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
11607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11608 no | no | yes | yes
11609 Arguments :
11610 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11611 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11612 as explained at the top of this document.
11613
11614 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
11615
11616
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011617timeout check <timeout>
11618 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
11619 established.
11620
11621 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11622 yes | no | yes | yes
11623 Arguments:
11624 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11625 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11626 as explained at the top of this document.
11627
11628 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
11629 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011630 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011631 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010011632 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
11633 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
11634 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011635
11636 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
11637 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
11638
11639 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
11640 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011641 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011642
11643 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11644 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11645 forget about it.
11646
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011647 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
11648 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011649
11650
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011651timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011652 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
11653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11654 yes | yes | yes | no
11655 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011656 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011657 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11658 as explained at the top of this document.
11659
11660 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11661 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11662 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010011663 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
11664 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
11665 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
11666 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011667 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
11668 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
11669 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011670 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011671 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011672 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
11673 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011674 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
11675 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011676
11677 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11678 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11679 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11680 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011681 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011682 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11683
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011684 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011685
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011686 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011687
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011688
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011689timeout client-fin <timeout>
11690 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
11691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11692 yes | yes | yes | no
11693 Arguments :
11694 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11695 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11696 as explained at the top of this document.
11697
11698 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11699 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11700 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11701 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11702 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
11703 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11704 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010011705 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
11706 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
11707 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011708
11709 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11710 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11711 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
11712
11713 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
11714
11715
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011716timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011717 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
11718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11719 yes | no | yes | yes
11720 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011721 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011722 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11723 as explained at the top of this document.
11724
11725 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011726 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011727 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011728 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011729 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
11730 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011731
11732 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11733 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11734 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11735 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011736 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011737 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11738
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011739 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011740
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011741
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011742timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
11743 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
11744 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11745 yes | yes | yes | yes
11746 Arguments :
11747 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11748 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11749 as explained at the top of this document.
11750
11751 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
11752 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
11753 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
11754 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
11755 once the request has started to present itself.
11756
11757 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
11758 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
11759 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
11760 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
11761 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
11762
11763 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
11764 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
11765 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
11766 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
11767
11768 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
11769 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011770 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011771 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
11772 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011773 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011774
11775 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
11776 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
11777 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
11778 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
11779
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011780 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
11781 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011782 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
11783
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011784 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
11785
11786
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011787timeout http-request <timeout>
11788 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
11789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011790 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011791 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011792 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011793 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11794 as explained at the top of this document.
11795
11796 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
11797 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
11798 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
11799 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
11800 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
11801 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
11802 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020011803 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
11804 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
11805 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
11806 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011807 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011808 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
11809 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011810
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011811 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
11812 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
11813 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
11814 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
11815 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011816 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011817
11818 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
11819 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011820 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011821 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
11822 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
11823
11824 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011825 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
11826 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
11827 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011828
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011829 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011830 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011831
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011832
11833timeout queue <timeout>
11834 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
11835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11836 yes | no | yes | yes
11837 Arguments :
11838 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11839 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11840 as explained at the top of this document.
11841
11842 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
11843 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
11844 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
11845 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
11846 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
11847
11848 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
11849 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
11850 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
11851 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
11852
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011853 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011854
11855
11856timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011857 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
11858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11859 yes | no | yes | yes
11860 Arguments :
11861 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11862 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11863 as explained at the top of this document.
11864
11865 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11866 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11867 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
11868 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
11869 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
11870 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
11871 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
11872
11873 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11874 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11875 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
11876 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
11877 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011878 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011879 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011880 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
11881 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011882 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
11883 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011884
11885 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11886 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11887 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11888 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011889 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011890 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11891
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011892 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011893
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011894
11895timeout server-fin <timeout>
11896 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
11897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11898 yes | no | yes | yes
11899 Arguments :
11900 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11901 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11902 as explained at the top of this document.
11903
11904 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11905 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11906 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11907 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11908 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
11909 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11910 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
11911 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
11912 situations, it should not be needed.
11913
11914 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11915 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11916 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
11917
11918 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
11919
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011920
11921timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011922 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011923 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11924 yes | yes | yes | yes
11925 Arguments :
11926 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
11927 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11928 as explained at the top of this document.
11929
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020011930 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
11931 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
11932 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011933
11934 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11935 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11936 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
11937 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011938 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011939
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011940 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011941
11942
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011943timeout tunnel <timeout>
11944 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
11945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11946 yes | no | yes | yes
11947 Arguments :
11948 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11949 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11950 as explained at the top of this document.
11951
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011952 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011953 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
11954 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
11955 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011956 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
11957 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011958 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
11959 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
11960 specified.
11961
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011962 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
11963 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
11964 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
11965 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
11966 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
11967 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
11968 state.
11969
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011970 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11971 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11972 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
11973 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011974 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011975
11976 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11977 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11978 forget about it.
11979
11980 Example :
11981 defaults http
11982 option http-server-close
11983 timeout connect 5s
11984 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011985 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011986 timeout server 30s
11987 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
11988
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011989 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011990
11991
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011992transparent (deprecated)
11993 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011995 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011996 Arguments : none
11997
11998 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
11999 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
12000 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
12001 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
12002 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
12003 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
12004 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
12005 appropriate server.
12006
12007 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
12008
12009 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
12010 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
12011
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012012 See also: "option transparent"
12013
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012014unique-id-format <string>
12015 Generate a unique ID for each request.
12016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12017 yes | yes | yes | no
12018 Arguments :
12019 <string> is a log-format string.
12020
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012021 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
12022 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
12023 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
12024 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012025
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012026 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
12027 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
12028 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
12029 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
12030 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
12031 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
12032 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
12033 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012034
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012035 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
12036 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012037
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012038 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012039
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012040 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012041
12042 will generate:
12043
12044 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12045
12046 See also: "unique-id-header"
12047
12048unique-id-header <name>
12049 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
12050 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12051 yes | yes | yes | no
12052 Arguments :
12053 <name> is the name of the header.
12054
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012055 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
12056 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012057
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012058 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012059
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012060 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012061 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
12062
12063 will generate:
12064
12065 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12066
12067 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012068
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012069use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012070 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12072 no | yes | yes | no
12073 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012074 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
12075 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012076
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012077 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
12078 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012079
12080 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
12081 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
12082 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012083 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012084 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012085 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
12086 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012087
12088 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
12089 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
12090 assign the backend.
12091
12092 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
12093 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12094 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
12095 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
12096 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
12097 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
12098
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012099 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012100 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012101 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
12102 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
12103 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
12104
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012105 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
12106 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
12107 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
12108 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
12109 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
12110 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
12111 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
12112 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
12113 cannot be forced from the request.
12114
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012115 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012116 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
12117 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
12118
12119 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
12120 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012121
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012122use-fcgi-app <name>
12123 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
12124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12125 no | no | yes | yes
12126 Arguments :
12127 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
12128
12129 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012130
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012131use-server <server> if <condition>
12132use-server <server> unless <condition>
12133 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
12134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12135 no | no | yes | yes
12136 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012137 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
12138 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012139
12140 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
12141
12142 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
12143 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
12144 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
12145
12146 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
12147 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
12148 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
12149 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
12150 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
12151 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
12152 matches will assign the server.
12153
12154 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
12155 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
12156 with the next rules until one matches.
12157
12158 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
12159 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12160 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
12161 according to other persistence mechanisms.
12162
12163 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
12164 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
12165 stripped.
12166
12167 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
12168 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
12169 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
12170 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
12171
12172 Example :
12173 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
12174 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
12175 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
12176 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
12177 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
12178 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000012179 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012180 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
12181 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
12182
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012183 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
12184 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
12185 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
12186 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050012187 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012188 and we fall back to load balancing.
12189
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012190 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012191
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012192
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100121935. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012194--------------------------
12195
12196The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
12197depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
12198settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
12199written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
12200described in this section.
12201
12202
122035.1. Bind options
12204-----------------
12205
12206The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
12207as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
12208no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
12209parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
12210while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
12211provided immediately after the setting name.
12212
12213The currently supported settings are the following ones.
12214
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012215accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
12216 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
12217 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
12218 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
12219 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
12220 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
12221 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
12222 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
12223 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
12224 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012225 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
12226 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
12227 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012228
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012229accept-proxy
12230 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020012231 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
12232 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012233 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
12234 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
12235 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
12236 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012237 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012238 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
12239 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012240 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
12241 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012242
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012243allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010012244 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012245 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012246 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012247 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
12248 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012249
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012250alpn <protocols>
12251 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12252 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12253 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012254 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012255 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012256 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
12257 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12258 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
12259 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
12260 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
12261 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
12262 preference, like below :
12263
12264 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012265
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012266backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010012267 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012268 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
12269
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010012270curves <curves>
12271 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12272 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
12273 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
12274 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
12275 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
12276 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
12277
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012278ecdhe <named curve>
12279 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010012280 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
12281 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012282
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012283ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012284 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12285 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12286 client's certificate.
12287
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012288ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
12289 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12290 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
12291 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
12292 error is ignored.
12293
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012294ca-sign-file <cafile>
12295 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12296 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
12297 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
12298 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12299 'generate-certificates' for details.
12300
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000012301ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012302 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
12303 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
12304 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12305 'generate-certificates' for details.
12306
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012307ca-verify-file <cafile>
12308 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
12309 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
12310 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
12311 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
12312 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
12313
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012314ciphers <ciphers>
12315 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12316 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000012317 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012318 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012319 information and recommendations see e.g.
12320 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12321 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12322 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
12323
12324ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12325 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12326 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
12327 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
12328 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012329 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
12330 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012331
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012332crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012333 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12334 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12335 to verify client's certificate.
12336
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012337crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012338 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12339 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
12340 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
12341 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
12342 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010012343 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
12344 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012345
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010012346 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
12347 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
12348
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012349 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
12350 are loaded.
12351
12352 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010012353 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
12354 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
12355 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
12356 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
12357 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
12358 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
12359 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012360 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012361
12362 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
12363 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
12364 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
12365 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010012366 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
12367 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012368
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020012369 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012370
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012371 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012372 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012373 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
12374 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012375 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
12376 clients).
12377
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020012378 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
12379 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
12380 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
12381 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
12382 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
12383 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
12384 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
12385 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
12386 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
12387 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
12388 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
12389 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
12390 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
12391
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012392 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
12393 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
12394 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
12395 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
12396 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
12397
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012398 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
12399 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
12400 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
12401 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012402
12403 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
12404 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
12405 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
12406 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
12407 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
12408 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
12409 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
12410 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
12411 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
12412
12413 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
12414
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012415 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012416 a cert bundle.
12417
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012418 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012419 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
12420 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
12421 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
12422 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
12423 provide multi-cert support.
12424
12425 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
12426
12427 Filename | CN | SAN
12428 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
12429 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012430 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012431 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
12432 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
12433
12434 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
12435 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
12436 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
12437 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020012438 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
12439 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
12440 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012441
12442 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
12443 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
12444
12445 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
12446 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
12447 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
12448
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012449crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012450 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012451 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012452 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012453 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012454
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012455crt-list <file>
12456 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012457 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
12458 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012459
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012460 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
12461
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020012462 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
12463 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
12464 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
12465 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
12466 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012467
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012468 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
12469 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
12470 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
12471 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
12472 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
12473 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
12474 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
12475 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012476
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012477 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020012478 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020012479 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
12480 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
12481 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012482
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012483 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
12484
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012485 crt-list file example:
12486 cert1.pem
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012487 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012488 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012489 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012490 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012491
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012492defer-accept
12493 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12494 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
12495 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012496 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012497 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
12498 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
12499 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
12500 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
12501 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
12502 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
12503 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
12504
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012505expose-fd listeners
12506 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
12507 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020012508 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
12509 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012510 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012511
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012512force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012513 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012514 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012515 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012516 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012517
12518force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012519 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012520 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012521 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012522
12523force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012524 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012525 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012526 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012527
12528force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012529 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012530 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012531 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012532
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012533force-tlsv13
12534 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
12535 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012536 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012537
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012538generate-certificates
12539 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12540 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
12541 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
12542 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
12543 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
12544 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
12545 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
12546 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
12547 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
12548 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
12549 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
12550
12551 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
12552 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012553 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012554 certificate is used many times.
12555
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012556gid <gid>
12557 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
12558 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12559 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
12560 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
12561 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12562
12563group <group>
12564 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
12565 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
12566 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
12567 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
12568 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12569
12570id <id>
12571 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
12572 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
12573 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
12574 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
12575
12576interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010012577 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
12578 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
12579 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
12580 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
12581 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
12582 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010012583 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
12584 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
12585 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
12586 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
12587 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
12588 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012589
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012590level <level>
12591 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
12592 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
12593 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012594 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012595 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
12596 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
12597 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012598 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012599 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012600 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012601 all counters).
12602
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020012603severity-output <format>
12604 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
12605 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
12606 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
12607 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
12608 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
12609 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
12610 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
12611 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
12612 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
12613 rfc5424 convention.
12614
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012615maxconn <maxconn>
12616 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
12617 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
12618 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
12619 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
12620 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
12621 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
12622 eat all memory.
12623
12624mode <mode>
12625 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
12626 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
12627 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
12628 UNIX sockets.
12629
12630mss <maxseg>
12631 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
12632 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
12633 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
12634 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
12635 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
12636 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
12637 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
12638 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
12639 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
12640 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
12641 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
12642
12643name <name>
12644 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
12645 page.
12646
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012647namespace <name>
12648 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12649 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
12650 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12651 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12652
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012653nice <nice>
12654 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
12655 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
12656 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
12657 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
12658 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
12659 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
12660 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
12661 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
12662 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
12663 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
12664 one for an RDP socket.
12665
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012666no-ca-names
12667 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12668 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012669 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012670
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012671no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012672 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012673 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012674 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012675 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012676 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
12677 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012678
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012679no-tls-tickets
12680 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12681 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12682 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012683 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
12684 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012685 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12686 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12687 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012688
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012689no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012690 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012691 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012692 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012693 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012694 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12695 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012696
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012697no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012698 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012699 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012700 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012701 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012702 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12703 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012704
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012705no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012706 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012707 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012708 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012709 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012710 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12711 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012712
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012713no-tlsv13
12714 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12715 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
12716 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
12717 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012718 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12719 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012720
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012721npn <protocols>
12722 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12723 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12724 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012725 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012726 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012727 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12728 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
12729 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
12730 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
12731 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012732
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012733prefer-client-ciphers
12734 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
12735 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
12736 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020012737 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
12738 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
12739 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012740
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012741process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012742 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012743 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012744 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012745 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
12746 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
12747 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
12748 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012749 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012750 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
12751 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
12752 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
12753 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
12754 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012755
12756 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
12757
12758 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
12759 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
12760 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
12761 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
12762 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
12763 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
12764 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
12765 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020012766
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012767proto <name>
12768 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
12769 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
12770 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
12771 in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040012772 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012773 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080012774 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012775 h2" on the bind line.
12776
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012777ssl
12778 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012779 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012780 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
12781 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020012782 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
12783 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012784
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012785ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12786 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020012787 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
12788 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
12789 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012790 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12791
12792ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020012793 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
12794 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
12795 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
12796 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012797
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010012798strict-sni
12799 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
12800 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
12801 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
12802 See the "crt" option for more information.
12803
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012804tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012805 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012806 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
12807 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012808 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012809 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
12810 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
12811 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
12812 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
12813 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
12814 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
12815 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12816
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012817tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010012818 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012819 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
12820 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
12821 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
12822 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
12823 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
12824 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
12825 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020012826 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
12827 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
12828 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012829
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012830tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
12831 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010012832 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
12833 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
12834 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
12835 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
12836 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
12837 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
12838 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
12839 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
12840 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
12841 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012842 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
12843 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
12844
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012845transparent
12846 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12847 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
12848 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
12849 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
12850 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
12851 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
12852 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
12853 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
12854 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
12855 so check for support with your vendor.
12856
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012857v4v6
12858 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12859 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
12860 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
12861 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012862 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012863
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012864v6only
12865 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12866 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
12867 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012868 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
12869 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012870
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012871uid <uid>
12872 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
12873 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12874 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
12875 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
12876 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12877
12878user <user>
12879 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
12880 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12881 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
12882 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
12883 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12884
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012885verify [none|optional|required]
12886 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
12887 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
12888 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
12889 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
12890 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012891 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
12892 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
12893 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
12894 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012895
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200128965.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012897------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012898
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012899The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
12900which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
12901arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
12902settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
12903after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
12904Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
12905address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012906
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012907 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012908 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012909
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012910Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
12911keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
12912
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012913The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012914
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012915addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012916 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010012917 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
12918 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
12919 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
12920 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
12921 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012922
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012923agent-check
12924 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012925 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010012926 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
12927 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
12928 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012929
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012930 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012931 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020012932 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
12933 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
12934 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012935
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012936 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
12937 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
12938 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
12939 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
12940 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020012941
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012942 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012943 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012944
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012945 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12946 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
12947 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012948
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012949 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12950 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
12951 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012952
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012953 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
12954 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
12955 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
12956 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
12957 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012958 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012959 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012960
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012961 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
12962 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012963
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012964 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
12965 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
12966 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
12967 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
12968 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
12969 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
12970 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
12971 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
12972 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012973
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012974 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
12975 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012976 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
12977 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
12978 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010012979 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012980
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012981 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012982 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012983
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070012984agent-send <string>
12985 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
12986 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
12987 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
12988 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
12989 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
12990
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012991agent-inter <delay>
12992 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
12993 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12994
12995 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
12996 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
12997 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
12998 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
12999 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13000 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13001 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13002 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13003 of backends use the same servers.
13004
13005 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
13006
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010013007agent-addr <addr>
13008 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
13009
13010 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
13011 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
13012 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
13013 hostname, it will be resolved.
13014
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013015agent-port <port>
13016 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
13017
13018 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
13019
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013020allow-0rtt
13021 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020013022 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
13023 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013024
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013025alpn <protocols>
13026 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13027 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13028 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013029 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013030 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
13031 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
13032 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13033 now obsolete NPN extension.
13034 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
13035 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
13036
13037 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
13038
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013039backup
13040 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
13041 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
13042 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
13043 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013044 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
13045 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013046
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013047ca-file <cafile>
13048 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13049 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13050 server's certificate.
13051
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013052check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013053 This option enables health checks on a server:
13054 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
13055 considered available.
13056 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
13057 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
13058 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
13059 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
13060 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
13061 set.
13062 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
13063 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
13064 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
13065 exchanges succeed.
13066
13067 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
13068 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
13069 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
13070 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
13071 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050013072 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013073 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
13074
13075 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
13076 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
13077
13078 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
13079 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
13080
13081 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
13082 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
13083 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
13084 available.
13085
13086 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
13087 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
13088 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
13089
13090 Example:
13091 # simple tcp check
13092 backend foo
13093 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
13094 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
13095 backend foo
13096 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
13097 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
13098 backend foo
13099 option tcp-check
13100 tcp-check connect
13101 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013102
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020013103check-send-proxy
13104 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
13105 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
13106 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
13107 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
13108 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
13109 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
13110 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
13111
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010013112check-alpn <protocols>
13113 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
13114 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
13115 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
13116
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013117check-proto <name>
13118 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
13119 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
13120 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
13121 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013122 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013123 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
13124 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
13125
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013126check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013127 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013128 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
13129 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013130
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013131check-ssl
13132 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
13133 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
13134 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
13135 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013136 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013137 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
13138 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013139 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013140 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
13141 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013142
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013143check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013144 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013145 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
13146 for normal traffic.
13147
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013148ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013149 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
13150 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
13151 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013152 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
13153 information and recommendations see e.g.
13154 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13155 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13156 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013157
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013158ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13159 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13160 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
13161 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
13162 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013163 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
13164 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
13165 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013166
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013167cookie <value>
13168 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
13169 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
13170 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
13171 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
13172 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
13173 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
13174 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
13175
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013176crl-file <crlfile>
13177 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13178 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13179 to verify server's certificate.
13180
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020013181crt <cert>
13182 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13183 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
13184 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
13185 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
13186 certificate request.
13187
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013188disabled
13189 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
13190 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
13191 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
13192 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
13193 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013194 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013195
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013196enabled
13197 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
13198 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
13199 default value.
13200 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
13201 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013202
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013203error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010013204 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
13205 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
13206 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013207
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013208 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013209
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013210fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013211 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
13212 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
13213 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
13214
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013215force-sslv3
13216 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13217 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013218 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013219 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013220
13221force-tlsv10
13222 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013223 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013224 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013225
13226force-tlsv11
13227 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013228 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013229 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013230
13231force-tlsv12
13232 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013233 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013234 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013235
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013236force-tlsv13
13237 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13238 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013239 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013240
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013241id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020013242 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
13243 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
13244 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013245
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013246init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
13247 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
13248 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013249 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013250 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
13251 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
13252 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
13253 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
13254 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
13255 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
13256 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
13257 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
13258 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013259 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013260 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
13261 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
13262 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
13263 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
13264 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
13265 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013266 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013267
13268 Example:
13269 defaults
13270 # never fail on address resolution
13271 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
13272
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013273inter <delay>
13274fastinter <delay>
13275downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013276 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
13277 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13278 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
13279 between checks depending on the server state :
13280
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020013281 Server state | Interval used
13282 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13283 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
13284 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13285 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
13286 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
13287 or yet unchecked. |
13288 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13289 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
13290 | "inter" otherwise.
13291 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013292
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013293 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
13294 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
13295 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
13296 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013297 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13298 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13299 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13300 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13301 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013302
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020013303log-proto <logproto>
13304 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
13305 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
13306 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
13307 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
13308
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013309maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013310 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
13311 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013312 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
13313 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013314 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
13315 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
13316 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
13317 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
13318
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013319 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
13320 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
13321 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
13322 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
13323 than 50 concurrent requests.
13324
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013325maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013326 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
13327 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
13328 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
13329 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
13330 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
13331 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
13332 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
13333
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010013334max-reuse <count>
13335 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
13336 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
13337 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
13338 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
13339 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
13340 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
13341 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
13342 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
13343
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013344minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013345 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
13346 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
13347 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
13348 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
13349 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
13350 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013351 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013352 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013353
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013354namespace <name>
13355 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13356 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
13357 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13358 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13359
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013360no-agent-check
13361 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
13362 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13363 default value.
13364 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13365 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
13366
13367no-backup
13368 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
13369 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13370 default value.
13371 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13372 "default-server" "backup" setting.
13373
13374no-check
13375 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
13376 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13377 default value.
13378 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13379 "default-server" "check" setting.
13380
13381no-check-ssl
13382 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
13383 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13384 default value.
13385 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13386 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
13387
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013388no-send-proxy
13389 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
13390 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13391 default value.
13392 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13393 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
13394
13395no-send-proxy-v2
13396 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
13397 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13398 default value.
13399 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13400 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
13401
13402no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
13403 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
13404 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13405 default value.
13406 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13407 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
13408
13409no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13410 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
13411 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13412 default value.
13413 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13414 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
13415
13416no-ssl
13417 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
13418 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13419 default value.
13420 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13421 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
13422
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010013423no-ssl-reuse
13424 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
13425 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
13426 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
13427 and for paranoid users.
13428
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013429no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013430 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13431 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013432 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013433
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013434 Supported in default-server: No
13435
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013436no-tls-tickets
13437 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13438 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13439 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013440 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
13441 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013442 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13443 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13444 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013445 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013446
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013447no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013448 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013449 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13450 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013451 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13452 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013453 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013454
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013455 Supported in default-server: No
13456
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013457no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013458 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013459 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13460 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013461 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13462 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013463 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013464
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013465 Supported in default-server: No
13466
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013467no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013468 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013469 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13470 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013471 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13472 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013473 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013474
13475 Supported in default-server: No
13476
13477no-tlsv13
13478 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13479 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13480 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
13481 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13482 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013483 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013484
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013485 Supported in default-server: No
13486
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013487no-verifyhost
13488 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
13489 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13490 default value.
13491 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13492 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013493
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013494no-tfo
13495 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
13496 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13497 default value.
13498 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13499 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
13500
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090013501non-stick
13502 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
13503 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
13504 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
13505
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013506npn <protocols>
13507 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13508 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13509 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013510 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013511 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
13512 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13513 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
13514
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013515observe <mode>
13516 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
13517 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
13518 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
13519 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
13520 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
13521 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010013522 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013523
13524 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
13525
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013526on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013527 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
13528 Currently, four modes are available:
13529 - fastinter: force fastinter
13530 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
13531 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
13532 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
13533 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
13534
13535 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
13536
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013537on-marked-down <action>
13538 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
13539 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013540 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
13541 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
13542 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
13543 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
13544 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
13545 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
13546 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
13547 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013548
13549 Actions are disabled by default
13550
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013551on-marked-up <action>
13552 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
13553 Currently one action is available:
13554 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
13555 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
13556 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
13557 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013558 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
13559 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013560 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
13561 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
13562
13563 Actions are disabled by default
13564
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020013565pool-low-conn <max>
13566 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
13567 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
13568 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
13569 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
13570 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
13571 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
13572 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
13573 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
13574 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
13575 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
13576 applying to "http-reuse".
13577
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010013578pool-max-conn <max>
13579 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
13580 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
13581 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
13582 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
13583 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
13584 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
13585
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013586pool-purge-delay <delay>
13587 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010013588 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020013589 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013590
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013591port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013592 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
13593 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
13594 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
13595 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
13596 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
13597 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
13598
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013599proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013600 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
13601 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
13602 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
13603 reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013604 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013605 protocol for all connections established to this server.
13606
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013607redir <prefix>
13608 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
13609 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
13610 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
13611 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
13612 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
13613 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
13614 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
13615 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013616 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013617 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013618 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
13619 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
13620 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
13621 loop between the client and HAProxy!
13622
13623 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
13624
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013625rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013626 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
13627 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
13628 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
13629
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013630resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
13631 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
13632 server.
13633
13634 Available options:
13635
13636 * allow-dup-ip
13637 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
13638 resolution at runtime is in operation.
13639 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
13640 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
13641 For such case, simply enable this option.
13642 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
13643
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050013644 * ignore-weight
13645 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
13646 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
13647 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
13648
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013649 * prevent-dup-ip
13650 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
13651 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
13652 same fqdn.
13653 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
13654
13655 Example:
13656 backend b_myapp
13657 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
13658 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13659 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13660
13661 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
13662 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
13663 it
13664 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
13665 different address
13666
13667 Default value: not set
13668
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013669resolve-prefer <family>
13670 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
13671 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
13672 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
13673 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
13674
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020013675 Default value: ipv6
13676
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013677 Example:
13678
13679 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013680
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013681resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013682 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013683 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013684 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013685 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
13686 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013687 configured network, another address is selected.
13688
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013689 Example:
13690
13691 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013692
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013693resolvers <id>
13694 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
13695 hostname.
13696
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013697 Example:
13698
13699 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013700
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013701 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013702
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013703send-proxy
13704 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
13705 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
13706 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
13707 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013708 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
13709 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
13710 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
13711 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
13712 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
13713 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
13714 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
13715 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
13716 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
13717 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013718 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
13719 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013720
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013721send-proxy-v2
13722 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
13723 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13724 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13725 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020013726 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
13727 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
13728 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
13729 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013730
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013731proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010013732 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
13733 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
13734
13735 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
13736 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
13737 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
13738 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
13739 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
13740 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
13741 connection is supported).
13742 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
13743 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
13744 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
13745 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
13746 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
13747 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
13748 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013749
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013750send-proxy-v2-ssl
13751 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13752 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13753 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13754 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13755 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13756 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
13757 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013758 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
13759 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013760
13761send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13762 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13763 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13764 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13765 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13766 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13767 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
13768 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
13769 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013770 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
13771 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013772
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013773slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013774 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
13775 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
13776 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
13777 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
13778 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
13779 parameters :
13780
13781 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
13782 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
13783
13784 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
13785 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
13786 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
13787 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
13788
13789 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
13790 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
13791 seen as failed.
13792
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013793sni <expression>
13794 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
13795 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
13796 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
13797 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020013798 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
13799 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013800 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010013801 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
13802 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013803
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013804source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020013805source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013806source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013807 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
13808 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
13809 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
13810 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
13811
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013812 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
13813 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
13814 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
13815 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
13816 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
13817 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
13818 server.
13819
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000013820 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
13821 specifying the source address without port(s).
13822
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013823ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020013824 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
13825 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
13826 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
13827 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
13828 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
13829 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013830 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
13831 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013832
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013833ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13834 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
13835 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13836 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13837
13838ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13839 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
13840 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13841 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
13842
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013843ssl-reuse
13844 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
13845 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13846 default value.
13847 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13848 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
13849
13850stick
13851 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
13852 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13853 default value.
13854 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13855 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013856
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013857socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013858 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013859 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
13860 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
13861
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013862tcp-ut <delay>
13863 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
13864 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
13865 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013866 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013867 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
13868 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
13869 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
13870 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
13871 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
13872 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
13873 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
13874 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
13875 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13876
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013877tfo
13878 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
13879 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
13880 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
13881 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
13882 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013883 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013884
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013885track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020013886 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
13887 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
13888 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
13889 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013890 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
13891
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013892tls-tickets
13893 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
13894 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13895 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013896 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13897 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13898 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013899 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010013900 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013901
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013902verify [none|required]
13903 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010013904 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013905 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
13906 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013907 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013908 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
13909 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
13910 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
13911 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
13912 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
13913 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
13914 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
13915 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013916
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070013917verifyhost <hostname>
13918 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013919 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
13920 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
13921 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
13922 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
13923 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
13924 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
13925 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
13926 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070013927
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013928weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013929 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
13930 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
13931 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020013932 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
13933 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
13934 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
13935 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
13936 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
13937 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013938
13939
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200139405.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
13941-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013942
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013943HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
13944using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
13945configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013946This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
13947can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
13948workload.
13949This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
13950resolution at run time.
13951Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
13952carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
13953
13954
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200139555.3.1. Global overview
13956----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013957
13958As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
13959different steps of the process life:
13960
13961 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
13962 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
13963 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
13964
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013965 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
13966 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013967
13968A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
13969 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
13970 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
13971 resolution to know this new IP.
13972
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013973When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013974HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013975SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
13976from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
13977will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
13978will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020013979
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013980A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013981 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013982 first valid response.
13983
13984 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
13985 servers return an error.
13986
13987
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200139885.3.2. The resolvers section
13989----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013990
13991This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013992HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
13993contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013994
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013995When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
13996uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
13997is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
13998answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
13999
14000When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014001used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014002
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014003 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
14004 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
14005 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014006
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014007 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
14008 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014009
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014010 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
14011 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
14012 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014013
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014014For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
14015following scenarios are possible:
14016
14017 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
14018 ignored
14019
14020 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
14021 applied
14022
14023 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
14024 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
14025
14026 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
14027 retries the query with a new type
14028
14029 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
14030 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014031
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014032As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
14033a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014034<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014035
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014036
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014037resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014038 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014039
14040A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
14041
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014042accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014043 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014044 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014045 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
14046 by RFC 6891)
14047
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020014048 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
14049
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014050nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
14051 DNS server description:
14052 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
14053 <ip> : IP address of the server
14054 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
14055
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014056parse-resolv-conf
14057 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
14058 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
14059 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
14060
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014061hold <status> <period>
14062 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
14063 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014064 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014065 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014066 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
14067 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14068 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
14069
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020014070 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014071
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014072resolve_retries <nb>
14073 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
14074 giving up.
14075 Default value: 3
14076
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014077 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
14078 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
14079 type.
14080
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014081timeout <event> <time>
14082 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
14083 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
14084 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014085 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
14086 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014087 Default value: 1s
14088 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014089 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014090 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014091 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14092 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
14093
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014094 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014095
14096 resolvers mydns
14097 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
14098 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014099 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014100 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014101 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014102 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014103 hold other 30s
14104 hold refused 30s
14105 hold nx 30s
14106 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014107 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014108 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014109
14110
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200141116. Cache
14112---------
14113
14114HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
14115(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
14116RAM.
14117
14118The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
14119this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
14120
14121If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
14122independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
14123when we try to allocate a new one.
14124
14125The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
14126
14127It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
14128"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
14129for more details.
14130
14131When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
14132replaced by "<CACHE>".
14133
14134
141356.1. Limitation
14136----------------
14137
14138The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
14139
14140- If the response is not a 200
14141- If the response contains a Vary header
14142- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
14143- If the response is not cacheable
14144
14145- If the request is not a GET
14146- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
14147- If the request contains an Authorization header
14148
14149
141506.2. Setup
14151-----------
14152
14153To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
14154the corresponding http-request and response actions.
14155
14156
141576.2.1. Cache section
14158---------------------
14159
14160cache <name>
14161 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
14162 size of cache is mandatory.
14163
14164total-max-size <megabytes>
14165 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
14166 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
14167
14168max-object-size <bytes>
14169 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
14170 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
14171 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
14172
14173max-age <seconds>
14174 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
14175 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
14176 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
14177 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
14178 default.
14179
14180
141816.2.2. Proxy section
14182---------------------
14183
14184http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14185 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
14186 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
14187 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
14188 after this one.
14189
14190http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14191 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
14192 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
14193 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
14194 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
14195
14196
14197Example:
14198
14199 backend bck1
14200 mode http
14201
14202 http-request cache-use foobar
14203 http-response cache-store foobar
14204 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
14205
14206 cache foobar
14207 total-max-size 4
14208 max-age 240
14209
14210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200142117. Using ACLs and fetching samples
14212----------------------------------
14213
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014214HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014215client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
14216The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
14217these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
14218but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
14219data called patterns.
14220
14221
142227.1. ACL basics
14223---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014224
14225The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
14226content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
14227from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
14228simple :
14229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014230 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014231 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014232 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
14233 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014235The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
14236adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014237
14238In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
14239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014240 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014241
14242This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
14243Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
14244and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014245an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
14246conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
14247as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
14248are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014249
14250ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
14251'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
14252which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
14253
14254There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
14255performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
14256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014257The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
14258specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
14259this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014260methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
14261ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014262
14263Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
14264 - boolean
14265 - integer (signed or unsigned)
14266 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
14267 - string
14268 - data block
14269
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014270Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
14271converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
14272would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
14273The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
14274which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
14275
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014276Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
14277keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
14278fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
14279which are summarized in the table below :
14280
14281 +---------------------+-----------------+
14282 | Sample or converter | Default |
14283 | output type | matching method |
14284 +---------------------+-----------------+
14285 | boolean | bool |
14286 +---------------------+-----------------+
14287 | integer | int |
14288 +---------------------+-----------------+
14289 | ip | ip |
14290 +---------------------+-----------------+
14291 | string | str |
14292 +---------------------+-----------------+
14293 | binary | none, use "-m" |
14294 +---------------------+-----------------+
14295
14296Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
14297matching method, see below.
14298
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014299The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
14300 - boolean
14301 - integer or integer range
14302 - IP address / network
14303 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
14304 - regular expression
14305 - hex block
14306
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014307The following ACL flags are currently supported :
14308
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014309 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
14310 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014311 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014312 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014313 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014314 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014315 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
14316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014317The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
14318read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
14319if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
14320lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
14321will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
14322beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
14323a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
14324lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
14325exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
14326
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014327The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
14328parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
14329ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
14330a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
14331check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
14332
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014333The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
14334socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
14335file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
14336
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014337Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
14338loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
14339
14340 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
14341
14342In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
14343the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
14344case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
14345as well.
14346
14347The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
14348sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
14349do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
14350methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
14351is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014352obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014353followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
14354default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
14355that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
14356string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
14357
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014358The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
14359By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
14360string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
14361resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
14362server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014363waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014364flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
14365function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
14366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014367There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
14368sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
14369be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014370
14371 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
14372 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014373 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
14374 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
14375 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
14376 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014377
14378 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
14379 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014380 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014381
14382 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014383 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014384
14385 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014386 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014387
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014388 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014389 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
14390
14391 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
14392 binary or string samples.
14393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014394 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
14395 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014397 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
14398 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
14399 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014401 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
14402 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014404 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
14405 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014407 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
14408 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014409
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014410 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
14411 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014412 This may be used with binary or string samples.
14413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014414 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
14415 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
14416 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014417
14418For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
14419request, it is possible to do :
14420
14421 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
14422
14423In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
14424buffer, one would use the following acl :
14425
14426 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
14427
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014428On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
14429possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
14430
14431 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
14432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014433All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
14434criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
14435method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
14436to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
14437criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
14438the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014440If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014441the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
14442For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014443
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014444 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
14445 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
14446 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
14447 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014448
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014449
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014450The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
14451types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
14452combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
14453brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
14454default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014456 +-------------------------------------------------+
14457 | Input sample type |
14458 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014459 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014460 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14461 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
14462 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014463 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014464 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014465 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014466 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014467 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014468 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014469 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014470 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014471 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014472 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014473 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014474 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014475 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014476 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014477 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014478 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014479 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014480 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014481 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014482 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014483 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014484 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14485 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
14486 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014487
14488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200144897.1.1. Matching booleans
14490------------------------
14491
14492In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
14493Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
14494When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
14495that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
14496
14497Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
14498return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
14499"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
14500
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200145027.1.2. Matching integers
14503------------------------
14504
14505Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
14506enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
14507to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
14508
14509Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
14510matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
14511lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014512
14513For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
14514unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
14515representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
14516
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014517As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
14518two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
14519instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
14520ranges and operators.
14521
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014522For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014523operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
14524Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
14525of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014526
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014527Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014528
14529 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
14530 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
14531 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
14532 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
14533 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
14534
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014535For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014536
14537 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
14538
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014539This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
14540
14541 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
14542
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014543
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200145447.1.3. Matching strings
14545-----------------------
14546
14547String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
14548different forms :
14549
14550 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014551 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014552
14553 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014554 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014555
14556 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
14557 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14558
14559 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
14560 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14561
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010014562 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014563 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
14564 matches.
14565
14566 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
14567 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
14568 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014569
14570String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
14571exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
14572characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
14573string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
14574to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014575before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014576
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010014577Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
14578(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
14579Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
14580
14581Example:
14582 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
14583 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
14584
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200145867.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
14587---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014588
14589Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
14590they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
14591possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
14592passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
14593the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014594the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
14595match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014596
14597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200145987.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
14599-------------------------------------
14600
14601It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
14602not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
14603a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
14604to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
14605digits may be used upper or lower case.
14606
14607Example :
14608 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
14609 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
14610
14611
146127.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
14613---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014614
14615IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
14616netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
14617within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014618host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014619difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
14620at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
14621does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
14622parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014623
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020014624The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
14625abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
14626
14627 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14628 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
14629 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14630 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
14631 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
14632 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
14633 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
14634 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14635
14636Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
14637192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
14638
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014639IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
14640Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
14641trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
14642IPv6 patterns.
14643
14644HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
14645following situations :
14646 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
14647 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
14648 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
14649 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
14650 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
14651 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
14652 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
14653 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
14654 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
14655 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
14656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014657
146587.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
14659----------------------------------
14660
14661Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
14662combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
14663
14664 - AND (implicit)
14665 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
14666 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014668A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014670 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014672Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
14673indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014675For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
14676"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
14677requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
14678is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
14679
14680 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014681 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
14682 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
14683 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014684
14685To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
14686and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
14687
14688 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
14689 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
14690 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
14691 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
14692
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014693 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014694 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
14695 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
14696 use_backend www if host_www
14697
14698It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
14699expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
14700be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
14701the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
14702
14703 The following rule :
14704
14705 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014706 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014707
14708 Can also be written that way :
14709
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014710 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014711
14712It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
14713to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
14714simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
14715sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
14716good use is the following :
14717
14718 With named ACLs :
14719
14720 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
14721 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
14722 monitor fail if site_dead
14723
14724 With anonymous ACLs :
14725
14726 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
14727
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014728See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
14729keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014730
14731
147327.3. Fetching samples
14733---------------------
14734
14735Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
14736against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
14737sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
14738ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
14739of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
14740available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
14741
14742This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
14743Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
14744compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
14745deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
14746
14747The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
14748matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
14749method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
14750indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
14751
14752As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
14753when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
14754mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
14755the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
14756ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
14757
14758Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
14759multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
14760when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014761incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
14762are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014763is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
14764all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
14765
14766Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
14767 - name
14768 - name(arg1)
14769 - name(arg1,arg2)
14770
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014771
147727.3.1. Converters
14773-----------------
14774
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014775Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
14776of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
14777is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
14778was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014779has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014780unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
14781
14782These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
14783sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
14784the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014785support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014786
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014787A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
14788support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
14789supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
14790(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
14791bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
14792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014793The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014794
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001479551d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
14796 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14797 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14798 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
14799 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14800 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14801
14802 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014803 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
14804 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000014805 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
14806 frontend http-in
14807 bind *:8081
14808 default_backend servers
14809 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14810 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14811
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014812add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014813 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014814 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014815 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
14816 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014817 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014818 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14819 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14820 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14821 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014822 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014823 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014824
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010014825aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
14826 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
14827 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
14828 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
14829 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
14830 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
14831 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
14832
14833 Example:
14834 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
14835 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
14836
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014837and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014838 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014839 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014840 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14841 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014842 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014843 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14844 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14845 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14846 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014847 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014848 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014849
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020014850b64dec
14851 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
14852 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
14853
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014854base64
14855 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014856 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014857 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
14858
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014859bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014860 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014861 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014862 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014863 presence of a flag).
14864
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014865bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
14866 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
14867 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014868 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014869
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014870concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
14871 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
14872 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
14873 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
14874 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
14875 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
14876 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
14877 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
14878 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
14879 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
14880 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014881 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014882 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014883 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
14884 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014885
14886 Example:
14887 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
14888 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
14889 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014890 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014891 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
14892
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014893cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014894 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
14895 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014896
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014897crc32([<avalanche>])
14898 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
14899 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14900 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14901 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14902 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14903 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
14904 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
14905 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
14906 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
14907 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014908 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
14909
14910crc32c([<avalanche>])
14911 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
14912 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14913 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14914 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
14915 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
14916 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
14917 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
14918 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014919
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020014920cut_crlf
14921 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
14922 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
14923 updated.
14924
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010014925da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014926 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
14927 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
14928 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
14929 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014930 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014931 configuration language.
14932
14933 Example:
14934 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014935 bind *:8881
14936 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014937 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014938
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010014939debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
14940 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
14941 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
14942 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
14943 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
14944 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
14945 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
14946 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
14947 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
14948 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
14949 printable sample types.
14950
14951 Example:
14952 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020014953
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020014954digest(<algorithm>)
14955 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
14956 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
14957
14958 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
14959 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
14960
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014961div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014962 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14963 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014964 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014965 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
14966 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014967 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014968 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14969 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14970 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14971 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014972 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014973 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014974
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014975djb2([<avalanche>])
14976 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
14977 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14978 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14979 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14980 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14981 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14982 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014983 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
14984 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014985
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014986even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014987 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014988 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
14989
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014990field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14991 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
14992 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
14993 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
14994 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
14995 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
14996 fields.
14997
14998 Example :
14999 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
15000 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15001 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
15002 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
15003 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010015004
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015005hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015006 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015007 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015008 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015009 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010015010
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015011hex2i
15012 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015013 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015014
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020015015htonl
15016 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
15017 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
15018 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
15019 unsigned 32-bit integer.
15020
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015021hmac(<algorithm>, <key>)
15022 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
15023 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
15024 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
15025 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
15026
15027 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15028 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15029
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015030http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015031 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15032 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015033 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
15034 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
15035 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
15036 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
15037 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
15038 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
15039 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
15040 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015041
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015042in_table(<table>)
15043 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15044 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
15045 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015046 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015047 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
15048
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015049ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
15050 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015051 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015052 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
15053 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
15054 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
15055 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
15056 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015057
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015058json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015059 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015060 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015061 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015062 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
15063 of errors:
15064 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
15065 bytes, ...)
15066 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
15067 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
15068
15069 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
15070 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
15071 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
15072 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
15073 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
15074 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015075 - "ascii" : never fails;
15076 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
15077 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015078 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015079 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015080 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
15081 characters corresponding to the other errors.
15082
15083 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015084 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015085
15086 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015087 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015088 capture request header user-agent len 150
15089 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015090
15091 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
15092 GET / HTTP/1.0
15093 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
15094
15095 Output log:
15096 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
15097
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015098language(<value>[,<default>])
15099 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
15100 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
15101 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
15102 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
15103 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
15104 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
15105 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
15106 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
15107 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015108 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015109 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
15110 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015111
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015112 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015113
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015114 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
15115 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015116
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015117 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
15118 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
15119 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
15120 use_backend spanish if es
15121 use_backend french if fr
15122 use_backend english if en
15123 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015124
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010015125length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010015126 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
15127 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15128 type. The result is of type integer.
15129
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015130lower
15131 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
15132 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15133 type. The result is of type string.
15134
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015135ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
15136 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15137 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
15138 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15139 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15140 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15141 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
15142
15143 Example :
15144
15145 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015146 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015147 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15148
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020015149ltrim(<chars>)
15150 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
15151 representation of the input sample.
15152
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015153map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15154map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15155map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15156 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
15157 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
15158 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
15159 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
15160 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
15161 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
15162 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
15163 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015164
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015165 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
15166 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
15167 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015168
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015169 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015170 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015171
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015172 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
15173 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15174 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
15175 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020015176 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
15177 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015178 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
15179 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15180 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
15181 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15182 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
15183 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15184 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
15185 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080015186 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
15187 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15188 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015189 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15190 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
15191 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15192 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
15193 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015194
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010015195 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
15196 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
15197 the corresponding match text.
15198
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015199 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
15200 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
15201 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
15202 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
15203 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015204
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015205 Example :
15206
15207 # this is a comment and is ignored
15208 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
15209 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
15210 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
15211 | | | `---------- value
15212 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
15213 | `---------------------------- key
15214 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
15215
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015216mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015217 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15218 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015219 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015220 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015221 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015222 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15223 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15224 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15225 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015226 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015227 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015228
15229mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015230 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020015231 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
15232 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015233 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015234 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015235 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015236 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15237 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15238 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15239 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015240 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015241 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015242
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010015243nbsrv
15244 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
15245 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
15246 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
15247 map lookup.
15248
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015249neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015250 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
15251 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
15252 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
15253 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015254
15255not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015256 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015257 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015258 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015259 absence of a flag).
15260
15261odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015262 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015263 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
15264
15265or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015266 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015267 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015268 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15269 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015270 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015271 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15272 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15273 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15274 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015275 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015276 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015277
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015278protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
15279 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
15280 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
15281 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
15282 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
15283 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15284 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15285 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15286 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
15287 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
15288 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15289 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
15290
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010015291regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015292 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
15293 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
15294 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
15295 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
15296 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
15297 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
15298 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
15299 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
15300 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015301 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
15302 of characters with other ones.
15303
15304 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
15305 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
15306 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
15307 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
15308 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
15309 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015310
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015311 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015312
15313 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
15314 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
15315 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015316 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015317
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015318 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
15319 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
15320
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015321 # capture groups and backreferences
15322 # both lines do the same.
15323 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)]'
15324 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
15325
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015326capture-req(<id>)
15327 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
15328 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15329
15330 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015331 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15332 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015333
15334capture-res(<id>)
15335 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
15336 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15337
15338 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015339 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15340 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015341
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020015342rtrim(<chars>)
15343 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
15344 of the input sample.
15345
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015346sdbm([<avalanche>])
15347 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
15348 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15349 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15350 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15351 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15352 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15353 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015354 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
15355 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015356
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015357secure_memcmp(<var>)
15358 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
15359 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
15360 match.
15361
15362 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
15363 performed in constant time.
15364
15365 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15366 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15367
15368 Example :
15369
15370 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
15371 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
15372 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
15373 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
15374
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015375set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015376 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
15377 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
15378 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015379 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015380 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15381 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015382 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015383 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15384 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015385 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015386 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015387
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015388sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015389 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015390 sample with length of 20 bytes.
15391
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015392sha2([<bits>])
15393 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
15394 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
15395
15396 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
15397 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
15398
15399 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15400 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15401
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020015402srv_queue
15403 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
15404 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
15405 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
15406 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
15407 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
15408
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015409strcmp(<var>)
15410 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
15411 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
15412 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
15413 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
15414 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
15415 shorter).
15416
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015417 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
15418 strings in constant time.
15419
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015420 Example :
15421
15422 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
15423 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
15424 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
15425
15426
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015427sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015428 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
15429 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015430 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015431 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
15432 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015433 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015434 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15435 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015436 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015437 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15438 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015439 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015440 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015441
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015442table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
15443 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15444 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15445 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
15446 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15447 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15448 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
15449
15450
15451table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
15452 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15453 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15454 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
15455 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15456 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15457 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
15458
15459table_conn_cnt(<table>)
15460 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15461 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015462 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015463 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
15464 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15465
15466table_conn_cur(<table>)
15467 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15468 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15469 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15470 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15471 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
15472
15473table_conn_rate(<table>)
15474 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15475 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15476 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
15477 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15478 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
15479
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015480table_gpt0(<table>)
15481 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15482 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
15483 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15484 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15485 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
15486
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015487table_gpc0(<table>)
15488 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15489 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15490 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15491 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15492 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
15493
15494table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
15495 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15496 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15497 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
15498 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15499 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
15500 sample fetch keyword.
15501
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015502table_gpc1(<table>)
15503 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15504 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15505 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
15506 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15507 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
15508
15509table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
15510 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15511 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15512 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
15513 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15514 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
15515 sample fetch keyword.
15516
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015517table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
15518 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15519 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015520 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015521 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15522 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15523
15524table_http_err_rate(<table>)
15525 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15526 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15527 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
15528 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
15529 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
15530 keyword.
15531
15532table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
15533 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15534 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015535 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015536 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
15537 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15538
15539table_http_req_rate(<table>)
15540 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15541 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15542 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
15543 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
15544 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
15545 keyword.
15546
15547table_kbytes_in(<table>)
15548 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15549 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015550 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015551 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15552 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15553 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
15554 keyword.
15555
15556table_kbytes_out(<table>)
15557 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15558 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015559 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015560 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15561 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15562 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
15563 keyword.
15564
15565table_server_id(<table>)
15566 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15567 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15568 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
15569 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
15570 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
15571 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
15572
15573table_sess_cnt(<table>)
15574 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15575 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015576 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015577 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
15578 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15579 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
15580 keyword.
15581
15582table_sess_rate(<table>)
15583 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15584 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15585 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
15586 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
15587 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15588 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
15589 keyword.
15590
15591table_trackers(<table>)
15592 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15593 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15594 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15595 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
15596 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
15597 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
15598 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
15599 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
15600 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
15601 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
15602
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015603upper
15604 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
15605 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15606 type. The result is of type string.
15607
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020015608url_dec([<in_form>])
15609 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
15610 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
15611 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
15612 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
15613 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
15614 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020015615
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015616ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015617 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015618 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
15619 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
15620 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015621 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15622 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15623 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15624 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015625 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015626 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15627 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015628
15629 Example:
15630 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
15631 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
15632
15633 message Point {
15634 int32 latitude = 1;
15635 int32 longitude = 2;
15636 }
15637
15638 message PPoint {
15639 Point point = 59;
15640 }
15641
15642 message Rectangle {
15643 // One corner of the rectangle.
15644 PPoint lo = 48;
15645 // The other corner of the rectangle.
15646 PPoint hi = 49;
15647 }
15648
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015649 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
15650 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
15651 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015652
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015653 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15654 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015655 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015656 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
15657
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015658 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015659
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015660 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015661
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015662 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
15663 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15664 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015665
15666 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
15667 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
15668 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
15669
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015670 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
15671 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
15672 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015673
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015674
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010015675unset-var(<var name>)
15676 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
15677 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
15678 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
15679 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15680 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
15681 response),
15682 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15683 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
15684 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
15685 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
15686
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015687utime(<format>[,<offset>])
15688 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15689 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
15690 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15691 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15692 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15693 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
15694
15695 Example :
15696
15697 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015698 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015699 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15700
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015701word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15702 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
15703 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
15704 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015705 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015706 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
15707 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
15708
15709 Example :
15710 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
15711 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15712 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
15713 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
15714 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015715 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010015716
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015717wt6([<avalanche>])
15718 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
15719 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15720 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15721 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15722 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15723 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15724 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015725 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
15726 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015727
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015728xor(<value>)
15729 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015730 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015731 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015732 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015733 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015734 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15735 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015736 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015737 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15738 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015739 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015740 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015741
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010015742xxh32([<seed>])
15743 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
15744 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15745 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15746 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15747 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15748 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15749 as cryptographically secure.
15750
15751xxh64([<seed>])
15752 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
15753 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15754 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15755 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15756 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15757 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15758 as cryptographically secure.
15759
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015760
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200157617.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015762--------------------------------------------
15763
15764A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
15765not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
15766"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
15767The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
15768
15769always_false : boolean
15770 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15771 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15772
15773always_true : boolean
15774 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15775 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15776
15777avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015778 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015779 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
15780 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
15781 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
15782 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
15783 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
15784 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
15785 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
15786 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
15787 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
15788 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
15789 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
15790 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
15791 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010015792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015793be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015794 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
15795 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
15796 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
15797 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015798 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
15799
15800be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
15801 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15802 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
15803 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
15804 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
15805 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015806 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
15807 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015808
15809 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
15810 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
15811 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015813be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
15814 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15815 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15816 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015817 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015818 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
15819 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015820
15821 Example :
15822 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
15823 backend dynamic
15824 mode http
15825 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
15826 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015827
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015828bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015829 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
15830 of the string.
15831
15832bool(<bool>) : bool
15833 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
15834 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
15835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015836connslots([<backend>]) : integer
15837 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015838 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015839 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
15840 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050015841
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015842 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015843 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015844 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
15845
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015846 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
15847 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015848
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015849 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015850 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015851 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015852 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015853 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015854 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015855 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015856
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015857 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
15858 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015859 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015860 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015861
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015862cpu_calls : integer
15863 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
15864 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
15865 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
15866 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
15867 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
15868 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
15869
15870cpu_ns_avg : integer
15871 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
15872 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15873 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15874 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15875 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15876 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15877 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
15878 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
15879 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
15880 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
15881 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
15882
15883cpu_ns_tot : integer
15884 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
15885 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15886 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15887 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15888 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15889 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15890 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
15891 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
15892 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
15893 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
15894 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
15895 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
15896 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
15897
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015898date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020015899 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015900
15901 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
15902 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
15903 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020015904 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
15905
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015906 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
15907 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
15908 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
15909 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
15910 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
15911
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020015912 Example :
15913
15914 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
15915 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020015916
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015917 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
15918 # millisecond granularity
15919 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
15920
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010015921date_us : integer
15922 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
15923 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
15924 from the same timeval structure.
15925
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020015926distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
15927 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
15928 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
15929 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
15930 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
15931 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
15932 list of supported tokens.
15933
15934distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
15935 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
15936 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
15937 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
15938 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
15939 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
15940 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
15941 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
15942 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
15943 supported tokens.
15944
15945 Example :
15946 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
15947 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
15948 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
15949 # send large files to the big farm
15950 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
15951
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020015952env(<name>) : string
15953 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
15954 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
15955 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
15956 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
15957 certain way.
15958
15959 Examples :
15960 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
15961 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
15962
15963 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
15964 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
15965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015966fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
15967 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015968 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
15969 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015970 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
15971 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015972 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015973 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
15974 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015975
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020015976fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
15977 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
15978 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
15979 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
15980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015981fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
15982 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15983 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15984 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
15985 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
15986 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
15987 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
15988 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
15989 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015990
15991 Example :
15992 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
15993 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
15994 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
15995 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
15996 frontend mail
15997 bind :25
15998 mode tcp
15999 maxconn 100
16000 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
16001 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
16002 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
16003 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016004
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010016005hostname : string
16006 Returns the system hostname.
16007
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016008int(<integer>) : signed integer
16009 Returns a signed integer.
16010
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016011ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
16012 Returns an ipv4.
16013
16014ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
16015 Returns an ipv6.
16016
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016017lat_ns_avg : integer
16018 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16019 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16020 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16021 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16022 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16023 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16024 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16025 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16026 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016027 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16028 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16029 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16030 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16031 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
16032 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016033
16034lat_ns_tot : integer
16035 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16036 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16037 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16038 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16039 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16040 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16041 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16042 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16043 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016044 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16045 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16046 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16047 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16048 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016049 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
16050 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
16051 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
16052 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
16053 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
16054 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
16055
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016056meth(<method>) : method
16057 Returns a method.
16058
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016059nbproc : integer
16060 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
16061 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
16062 and debugging purposes.
16063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016064nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
16065 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
16066 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
16067 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016068 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
16069 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
16070 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016071
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040016072prio_class : integer
16073 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
16074 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
16075 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
16076
16077prio_offset : integer
16078 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
16079 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
16080 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
16081 set-priority-offset".
16082
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016083proc : integer
16084 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
16085 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
16086 debugging purposes.
16087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016088queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016089 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
16090 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
16091 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016092 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
16093 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
16094 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
16095 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
16096 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
16097
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010016098rand([<range>]) : integer
16099 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
16100 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
16101 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
16102 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
16103 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
16104
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020016105uuid([<version>]) : string
16106 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
16107 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
16108 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
16109
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016110srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16111 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16112 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
16113 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
16114 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
16115 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016116 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
16117 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
16118
16119srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16120 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16121 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
16122 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16123 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
16124 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
16125 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
16126 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
16127
16128 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
16129 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016130
16131srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
16132 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
16133 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
16134 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016135 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016136 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
16137 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
16138 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
16139
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020016140srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16141 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
16142 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16143 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
16144 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
16145 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
16146 fetch methods.
16147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016148srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16149 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16150 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016151 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016152 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
16153 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016154 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016155 overloading servers).
16156
16157 Example :
16158 # Redirect to a separate back
16159 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
16160 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
16161 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
16162
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020016163srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16164 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
16165 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
16166 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
16167
16168srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16169 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
16170 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16171 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
16172
16173srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16174 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
16175 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16176 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
16177
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016178stopping : boolean
16179 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
16180 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
16181 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
16182
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016183str(<string>) : string
16184 Returns a string.
16185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016186table_avl([<table>]) : integer
16187 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
16188 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
16189
16190table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16191 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
16192 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
16193 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
16194
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010016195thread : integer
16196 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
16197 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
16198 and debugging purposes.
16199
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016200var(<var-name>) : undefined
16201 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016202 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
16203 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016204 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016205 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16206 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016207 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016208 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16209 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016210 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016211 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016212
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200162137.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016214----------------------------------
16215
16216The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
16217closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
16218methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
16219sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
16220TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016221the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
16222counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020016223"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
16224used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
16225can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
16226Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
16227table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
16228tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
16229currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016230
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010016231bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010016232 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16233 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16234 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
16235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016236be_id : integer
16237 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016238 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16239 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016240
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016241be_name : string
16242 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016243 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16244 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016246dst : ip
16247 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
16248 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
16249 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
16250 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016251 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
16252 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
16253 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
16254 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
16255 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
16256 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016257
16258dst_conn : integer
16259 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16260 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
16261 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
16262 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
16263 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
16264 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
16265 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
16266 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016267
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016268dst_is_local : boolean
16269 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
16270 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
16271 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
16272 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016273 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016274 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
16275 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
16276 it only once per connection.
16277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016278dst_port : integer
16279 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
16280 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
16281 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
16282 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
16283 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
16284 an HTTP header.
16285
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020016286fc_http_major : integer
16287 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16288 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16289 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
16290
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020016291fc_pp_authority : string
16292 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16293 if any.
16294
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010016295fc_pp_unique_id : string
16296 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16297 if any.
16298
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010016299fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
16300 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
16301 header.
16302
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020016303fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
16304 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
16305 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
16306 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
16307 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16308 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16309 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16310
16311fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
16312 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
16313 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
16314 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
16315 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16316 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16317 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16318
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016319fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016320 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16321 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16322 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16323 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16324
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016325fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016326 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16327 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16328 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16329 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16330
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016331fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016332 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
16333 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16334 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16335 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16336
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016337fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016338 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
16339 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16340 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16341 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16342
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016343fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016344 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
16345 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16346 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16347 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16348
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016349fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016350 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
16351 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16352 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16353 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16354
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020016355fe_defbe : string
16356 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
16357 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
16358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016359fe_id : integer
16360 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010016361 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016362 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16363
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016364fe_name : string
16365 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
16366 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
16367 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16368
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016369sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016370sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16371sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16372sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016373 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
16374 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16375 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
16376
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016377sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016378sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16379sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16380sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016381 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
16382 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16383 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
16384
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016385sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016386sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16387sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16388sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016389 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16390 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016391 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16392 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16393 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016394
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016395 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016396 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16397 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016398 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16399 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
16400 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016401 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16402 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16403
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016404sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16405sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16406sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16407sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16408 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16409 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
16410 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16411 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16412 when a first ACL was verified.
16413
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016414sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016415sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16416sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16417sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016418 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016419 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
16420
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016421sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016422sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16423sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16424sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016425 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16426 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
16427 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
16428
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016429sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016430sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16431sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16432sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016433 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
16434 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
16435 See also src_conn_rate.
16436
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016437sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016438sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16439sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16440sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016441 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016442 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016443
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016444sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16445sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16446sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16447sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16448 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16449 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16450
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016451sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16452sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16453sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16454sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16455 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16456 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
16457
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016458sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016459sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16460sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16461sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016462 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
16463 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16464 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016465 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16466 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16467 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016468
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016469sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16470sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16471sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16472sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16473 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16474 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16475 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16476 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16477 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16478 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16479
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016480sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016481sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16482sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16483sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016484 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016485 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
16486 See also src_http_err_cnt.
16487
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016488sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016489sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16490sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16491sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016492 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
16493 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16494 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
16495 src_http_err_rate.
16496
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016497sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016498sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16499sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16500sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016501 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016502 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16503 src_http_req_cnt.
16504
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016505sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016506sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16507sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16508sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016509 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
16510 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
16511 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16512 src_http_req_rate.
16513
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016514sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016515sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16516sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16517sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016518 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016519 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16520 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16521 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16522 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016523
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016524 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016525 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16526 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016527 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16528
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016529sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16530sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16531sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16532sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16533 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
16534 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16535 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16536 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16537 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
16538
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016539sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016540sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16541sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16542sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016543 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
16544 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16545 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016546
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016547sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016548sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16549sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16550sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016551 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
16552 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16553 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016554
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016555sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016556sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16557sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16558sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016559 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016560 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
16561 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
16562 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016563 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016564 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
16565
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016566sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016567sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16568sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16569sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016570 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
16571 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16572 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
16573 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
16574 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016575 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016576
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016577sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016578sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16579sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16580sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020016581 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
16582 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
16583 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
16584
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016585sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016586sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16587sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16588sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016589 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16590 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016591 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016592 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
16593 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016594 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
16595 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
16596 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016598so_id : integer
16599 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
16600 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
16601 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016602
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010016603so_name : string
16604 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
16605 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
16606 strings instead of integers.
16607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016608src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016609 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016610 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
16611 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
16612 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016613 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
16614 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
16615 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016616 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
16617 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
16618 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
16619 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
16620 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
16621 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
16622 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016623
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016624 Example:
16625 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
16626 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
16627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016628src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16629 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
16630 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
16631 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016632 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016634src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16635 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
16636 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016637 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016638 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016640src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16641 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16642 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16643 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16644 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16645 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16646 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016647
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016648 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016649 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16650 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
16651 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
16652 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016653 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016654 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16655 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16656
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016657src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16658 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16659 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16660 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16661 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16662 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16663 was verified.
16664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016665src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016666 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016667 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016668 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016669 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016670
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016671src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016672 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016673 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16674 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016675 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016677src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16678 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
16679 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16680 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016681 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016683src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016684 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016685 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016686 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016687 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016688
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016689src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16690 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16691 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16692 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16693 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
16694
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016695src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16696 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16697 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16698 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16699 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
16700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016701src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016702 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016703 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016704 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16705 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016706 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16707 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16708 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016709
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016710src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16711 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16712 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16713 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16714 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16715 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16716 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16717 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016719src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016720 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016721 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016722 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016723 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016724 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016726src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16727 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
16728 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16729 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16730 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016731 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016733src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016734 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016735 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16736 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016737 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016738
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016739src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16740 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
16741 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16742 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016743 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016744 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016746src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16747 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16748 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16749 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016750 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016751 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16752 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016753
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016754 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016755 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016756 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016757 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016758
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016759src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16760 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16761 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16762 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
16763 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16764 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16765 connection when a first ACL was verified.
16766
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016767src_is_local : boolean
16768 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
16769 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
16770 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
16771 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016772 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016773 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
16774 once per connection.
16775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016776src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016777 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
16778 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
16779 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
16780 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
16781 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016783src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016784 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
16785 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16786 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
16787 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
16788 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016790src_port : integer
16791 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
16792 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
16793 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
16794 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016796src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016797 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016798 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16799 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
16800 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016801 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016803src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16804 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
16805 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16806 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16807 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016808 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016810src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16811 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
16812 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
16813 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
16814 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
16815 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
16816 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
16817 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
16818 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016819
16820 Example :
16821 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
16822 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
16823 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
16824 listen ssh
16825 bind :22
16826 mode tcp
16827 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016828 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016829 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016830 server local 127.0.0.1:22
16831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016832srv_id : integer
16833 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
16834 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016835 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020016836
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016837srv_name : string
16838 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
16839 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016840 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016841
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200168427.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016843----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020016844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016845The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
16846closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
16847when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
16848usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016849future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016850
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001685151d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
16852 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16853 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16854 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
16855 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16856 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16857
16858 Example :
16859 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
16860 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
16861 # the request.
16862 frontend http-in
16863 bind *:8081
16864 default_backend servers
16865 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16866 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16867
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016868ssl_bc : boolean
16869 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16870 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016871 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16872 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016873
16874ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
16875 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016876 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
16877 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016878
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016879ssl_bc_alpn : string
16880 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
16881 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020016882 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016883 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16884 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16885 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
16886 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
16887 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016888 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
16889 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016890
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016891ssl_bc_cipher : string
16892 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016893 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16894 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016895
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016896ssl_bc_client_random : binary
16897 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
16898 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16899 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016900 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016901
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010016902ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
16903 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16904 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016905 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
16906 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010016907
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016908ssl_bc_npn : string
16909 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
16910 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020016911 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016912 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
16913 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
16914 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
16915 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016916 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
16917 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016918
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016919ssl_bc_protocol : string
16920 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016921 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16922 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016923
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016924ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016925 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016926 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016927 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
16928 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016929
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016930ssl_bc_server_random : binary
16931 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
16932 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16933 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016934 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016935
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016936ssl_bc_session_id : binary
16937 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
16938 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016939 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
16940 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016941
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016942ssl_bc_session_key : binary
16943 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
16944 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16945 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016946 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016947
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016948ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
16949 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016950 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
16951 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016953ssl_c_ca_err : integer
16954 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16955 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
16956 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
16957 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
16958 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016960ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
16961 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16962 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
16963 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
16964 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016965
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010016966ssl_c_der : binary
16967 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
16968 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16969 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
16970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016971ssl_c_err : integer
16972 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16973 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
16974 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
16975 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
16976 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016977
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016978ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016979 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16980 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
16981 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16982 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16983 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16984 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16985 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16986 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016987 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16988 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16989 LDAP v3.
16990 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16991 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016993ssl_c_key_alg : string
16994 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
16995 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16996 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016998ssl_c_notafter : string
16999 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
17000 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17001 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017003ssl_c_notbefore : string
17004 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
17005 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17006 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017007
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017008ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017009 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17010 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17011 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17012 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17013 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17014 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17015 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17016 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017017 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17018 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17019 LDAP v3.
17020 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17021 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017023ssl_c_serial : binary
17024 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
17025 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17026 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017028ssl_c_sha1 : binary
17029 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
17030 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
17031 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017032 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
17033 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
17034
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017035 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017036 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017038ssl_c_sig_alg : string
17039 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17040 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17041 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017043ssl_c_used : boolean
17044 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
17045 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017047ssl_c_verify : integer
17048 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
17049 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
17050 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
17051 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017053ssl_c_version : integer
17054 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
17055 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017056
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010017057ssl_f_der : binary
17058 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
17059 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17060 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17061
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017062ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017063 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17064 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17065 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17066 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017067 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017068 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17069 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17070 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017071 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17072 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17073 LDAP v3.
17074 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17075 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017077ssl_f_key_alg : string
17078 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17079 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
17080 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017081
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017082ssl_f_notafter : string
17083 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17084 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17085 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017087ssl_f_notbefore : string
17088 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17089 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17090 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017091
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017092ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017093 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17094 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17095 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17096 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17097 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17098 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17099 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17100 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017101 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17102 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17103 LDAP v3.
17104 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17105 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017107ssl_f_serial : binary
17108 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17109 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17110 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017111
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020017112ssl_f_sha1 : binary
17113 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
17114 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17115 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017117ssl_f_sig_alg : string
17118 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17119 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17120 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017122ssl_f_version : integer
17123 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17124 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17125
17126ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017127 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17128 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
17129 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
17130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017131 Example :
17132 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
17133 listen http-https
17134 bind :80
17135 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
17136 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
17137
17138ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
17139 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
17140 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17141
17142ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017143 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017144 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
17145 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
17146 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17147 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17148 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
17149 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
17150 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
17151 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
17152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017153ssl_fc_cipher : string
17154 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
17155 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020017156
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017157ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
17158 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
17159 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017160 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017161
17162ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
17163 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
17164 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017165 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017166
17167ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
17168 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
17169 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
17170 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017171 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020017172 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017173
17174ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
17175 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
17176 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017177 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017178
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017179ssl_fc_client_random : binary
17180 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17181 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17182 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17183
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017184ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
17185 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17186 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17187 transport layer.
17188 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17189 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17190 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17191 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17192
17193ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17194 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17195 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17196 transport layer.
17197 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17198 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17199 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17200 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17201
17202ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
17203 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17204 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17205 transport layer.
17206 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17207 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17208 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17209 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17210
17211ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
17212 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17213 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17214 transport layer.
17215 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17216 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17217 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17218 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17219
17220ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
17221 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17222 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17223 transport layer.
17224 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17225 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17226 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17227 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017229ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017230 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
17231 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010017232 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
17233 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
17234 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
17235 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017236
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020017237ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
17238 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
17239 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
17240 wait until the handshake happened.
17241
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017242ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
17243 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017244 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
17245 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017246 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017247 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017248
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020017249ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017250 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010017251 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
17252 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017254ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017255 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017256 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
17257 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
17258 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
17259 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
17260 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
17261 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
17262 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020017263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017264ssl_fc_protocol : string
17265 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
17266 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017267
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017268ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017269 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017270 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
17271 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017272
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017273ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17274 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17275 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17276 transport layer.
17277 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17278 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17279 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17280 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17281
17282ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
17283 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17284 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17285 transport layer.
17286 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17287 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17288 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17289 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17290
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017291ssl_fc_server_random : binary
17292 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17293 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17294 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017296ssl_fc_session_id : binary
17297 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
17298 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
17299 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
17300 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017301
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017302ssl_fc_session_key : binary
17303 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
17304 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17305 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
17306 BoringSSL.
17307
17308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017309ssl_fc_sni : string
17310 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
17311 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
17312 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
17313 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
17314 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
17315
17316 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
17317 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
17318 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017319 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020017320 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017321
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017322 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017323 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
17324 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020017325
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017326ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
17327 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
17328 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017329
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017330ssl_s_der : binary
17331 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
17332 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17333 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17334
17335ssl_s_key_alg : string
17336 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17337 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
17338 SSL/TLS transport layer.
17339
17340ssl_s_notafter : string
17341 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
17342 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17343 transport layer.
17344
17345ssl_s_notbefore : string
17346 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
17347 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17348 transport layer.
17349
17350ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17351 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17352 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17353 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17354 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17355 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17356 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017357 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17358 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017359 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17360 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17361 LDAP v3.
17362 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17363 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17364
17365ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17366 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17367 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17368 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17369 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17370 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17371 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017372 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17373 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017374 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17375 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17376 LDAP v3.
17377 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17378 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17379
17380ssl_s_serial : binary
17381 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
17382 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17383 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17384
17385ssl_s_sha1 : binary
17386 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
17387 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17388 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17389
17390ssl_s_sig_alg : string
17391 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17392 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17393 layer.
17394
17395ssl_s_version : integer
17396 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
17397 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017398
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200173997.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017400------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017401
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017402Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
17403sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
17404only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
17405For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
17406be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
17407can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
17408sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
17409for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
17410content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017412payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017413 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017414 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
17415 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017416
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017417payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
17418 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017419 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017420 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017421
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020017422req.hdrs : string
17423 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
17424 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
17425 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
17426 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
17427
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020017428req.hdrs_bin : binary
17429 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
17430 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
17431 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
17432 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
17433 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
17434 names and values (length of 0 for both).
17435
17436 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
17437
17438 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
17439 str: <int:length><bytes>
17440
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017441req.len : integer
17442req_len : integer (deprecated)
17443 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17444 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17445 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17446 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17447 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17448 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17449 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
17450 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017452req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17453 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017454 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
17455 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
17456 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
17457 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017459 ACL alternatives :
17460 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017462req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17463 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17464 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17465 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
17466 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017467
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017468 ACL alternatives :
17469 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017471 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017473req.proto_http : boolean
17474req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
17475 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
17476 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
17477 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
17478 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
17479 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
17480 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
17481 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017483 Example:
17484 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
17485 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17486 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017487 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017489req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
17490rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17491 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
17492 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
17493 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
17494 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
17495 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
17496 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
17497 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017498
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017499 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
17500 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
17501 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
17502 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
17503 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
17504 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017506 ACL derivatives :
17507 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017509 Example :
17510 listen tse-farm
17511 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
17512 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
17513 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17514 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
17515 # apply RDP cookie persistence
17516 persist rdp-cookie
17517 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
17518 # This is only useful makes sense if
17519 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
17520 stick-table type string size 204800
17521 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
17522 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
17523 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017524
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017525 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
17526 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017528req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
17529rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
17530 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
17531 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
17532 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
17533 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017535 ACL derivatives :
17536 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017537
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017538req.ssl_alpn : string
17539 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
17540 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
17541 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
17542 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
17543 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
17544 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017545 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017546
17547 Examples :
17548 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17549 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17550 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017551 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017552 default_backend bk_default
17553
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017554req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
17555 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
17556 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020017557 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
17558 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
17559 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
17560 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
17561 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017563req.ssl_hello_type : integer
17564req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17565 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17566 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
17567 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17568 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17569 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
17570 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17571 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017573req.ssl_sni : string
17574req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
17575 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
17576 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
17577 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
17578 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17579 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
17580 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
17581 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
17582 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
17583 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
17584 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
17585 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
17586 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017588 ACL derivatives :
17589 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017591 Examples :
17592 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17593 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17594 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
17595 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
17596 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017597
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053017598req.ssl_st_ext : integer
17599 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
17600 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
17601 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
17602 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
17603 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
17604 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
17605 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
17606 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
17607 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
17608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017609req.ssl_ver : integer
17610req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
17611 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
17612 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
17613 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
17614 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
17615 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17616 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
17617 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017618 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017619 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017621 ACL derivatives :
17622 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017623
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017624res.len : integer
17625 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17626 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17627 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17628 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17629 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17630 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17631 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017632 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017634res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17635 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017636 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017637 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017638 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017639 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017641res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17642 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17643 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17644 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017645 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
17646 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017648 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017649
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020017650res.ssl_hello_type : integer
17651rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17652 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17653 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
17654 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17655 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17656 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
17657 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17658 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
17659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017660wait_end : boolean
17661 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
17662 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017663 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017664 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
17665 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017666 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017667 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
17668 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017670 Examples :
17671 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
17672 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
17673 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017675 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
17676 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17677 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
17678 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
17679 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
17680 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
17681 tcp-request content reject
17682
17683
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200176847.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017685--------------------------------------
17686
17687It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
17688This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
17689data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
17690its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
17691HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
17692content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
17693to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
17694more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
17695response are indexed.
17696
17697base : string
17698 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
17699 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
17700 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
17701 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
17702 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
17703 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
17704 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
17705 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
17706
17707 ACL derivatives :
17708 base : exact string match
17709 base_beg : prefix match
17710 base_dir : subdir match
17711 base_dom : domain match
17712 base_end : suffix match
17713 base_len : length match
17714 base_reg : regex match
17715 base_sub : substring match
17716
17717base32 : integer
17718 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
17719 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
17720 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017721 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
17722 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
17723 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017724
17725base32+src : binary
17726 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
17727 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
17728 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
17729 per-URL counters.
17730
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017731capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
17732 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
17733 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17734 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
17735
17736capture.req.method : string
17737 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
17738 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
17739 because it's allocated.
17740
17741capture.req.uri : string
17742 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
17743 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
17744 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
17745 allocated.
17746
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017747capture.req.ver : string
17748 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17749 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
17750 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
17751
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017752capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
17753 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
17754 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17755 The first entry is an index of 0.
17756 See also: "capture response header"
17757
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017758capture.res.ver : string
17759 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17760 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
17761 persistent flag.
17762
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017763req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017764 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
17765 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
17766 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017767
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020017768req.body_param([<name>) : string
17769 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
17770 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
17771 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
17772 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
17773 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
17774 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
17775 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
17776 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
17777 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
17778 given.
17779
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017780req.body_len : integer
17781 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
17782 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017783 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
17784 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017785
17786req.body_size : integer
17787 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017788 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
17789 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017791req.cook([<name>]) : string
17792cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17793 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17794 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
17795 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
17796 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
17797 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
17798 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
17799 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
17800 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
17801
17802 ACL derivatives :
17803 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
17804 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
17805 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
17806 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
17807 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
17808 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
17809 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
17810 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017812req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17813cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17814 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
17815 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017817req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
17818cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17819 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17820 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
17821 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
17822 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017823
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017824cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17825 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17826 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
17827 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
17828 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020017829 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017830 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
17831 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
17832 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
17833 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017835hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17836 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
17837 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
17838 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
17839 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017840 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017842req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
17843 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17844 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17845 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17846 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17847 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17848 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
17849 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
17850 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017852req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17853 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
17854 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17855 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
17856 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017858req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17859 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17860 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17861 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17862 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17863 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17864 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
17865 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
17866 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000017867 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017868 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017869 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017871 ACL derivatives :
17872 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
17873 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
17874 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
17875 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
17876 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
17877 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
17878 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
17879 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
17880
17881req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17882hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
17883 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
17884 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
17885 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
17886 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
17887 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
17888 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
17889 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
17890 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
17891 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
17892
17893req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
17894hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
17895 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
17896 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
17897 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
17898 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
17899 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017900 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017901 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
17902 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
17903
17904req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
17905hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
17906 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
17907 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
17908 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
17909 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17910 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17911 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17912 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
17913
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010017914
17915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017916http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
17917 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
17918 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
17919 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
17920 basic auth is supported.
17921
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010017922http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
17923 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
17924 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
17925 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
17926 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017927 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
17928 basic auth is supported.
17929
17930 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010017931 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
17932 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
17933 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
17934 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017935
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017936http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017937 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
17938 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
17939 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017940
17941http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017942 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
17943 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
17944 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017945
17946http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017947 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
17948 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
17949 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017951http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020017952 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
17953 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017954 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
17955 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020017956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017957method : integer + string
17958 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
17959 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
17960 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
17961 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
17962 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
17963 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
17964 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017966 ACL derivatives :
17967 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017969 Example :
17970 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
17971 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
17972 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017974path : string
17975 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
17976 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
17977 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
17978 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
17979 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017980 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017981 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017983 ACL derivatives :
17984 path : exact string match
17985 path_beg : prefix match
17986 path_dir : subdir match
17987 path_dom : domain match
17988 path_end : suffix match
17989 path_len : length match
17990 path_reg : regex match
17991 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017992
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010017993query : string
17994 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
17995 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
17996 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
17997 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017998 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010017999 which stops before the question mark.
18000
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018001req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18002 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18003 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18004 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
18005 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
18006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018007req.ver : string
18008req_ver : string (deprecated)
18009 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
18010 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
18011 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018013 ACL derivatives :
18014 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018015
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018016res.body : binary
18017 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
18018 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
18019 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
18020 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
18021
18022res.body_len : integer
18023 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
18024 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
18025 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
18026 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
18027
18028res.body_size : integer
18029 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
18030 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18031 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
18032 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
18033 useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It may be used in tcp-check
18034 based expect rules.
18035
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018036res.comp : boolean
18037 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
18038 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
18039 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018041res.comp_algo : string
18042 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
18043 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
18044 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018046res.cook([<name>]) : string
18047scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18048 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18049 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018050 specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may be used in tcp-check
18051 based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018053 ACL derivatives :
18054 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018056res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18057scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18058 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18059 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018060 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses. It may
18061 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018063res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18064scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18065 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18066 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018067 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may
18068 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018070res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18071 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
18072 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
18073 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
18074 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
18075 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
18076 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
18077 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
18078 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018079 Expires. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018081res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18082 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
18083 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18084 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
18085 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018086 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in
18087 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018089res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18090shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
18091 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
18092 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
18093 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
18094 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
18095 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
18096 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
18097 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018098 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in tcp-check based
18099 expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018101 ACL derivatives :
18102 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18103 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18104 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18105 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18106 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18107 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18108 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18109 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18110
18111res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18112shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18113 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
18114 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18115 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
18116 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018117 instead. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018119res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18120shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18121 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
18122 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
18123 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
18124 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
18125 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018126 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table. It
18127 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018128
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018129res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18130 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18131 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18132 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018133 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered. It may be used
18134 in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018136res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18137shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18138 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
18139 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
18140 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
18141 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
18142 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018143 useful to learn some data into a stick table. It may be used in tcp-check
18144 based expect rules.
18145
18146res.hdrs : string
18147 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
18148 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
18149 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
18150 headers analyzers and for advanced logging. It may also be used in tcp-check
18151 based expect rules.
18152
18153res.hdrs_bin : binary
18154 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
18155 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
18156 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
18157 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
18158 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
18159 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
18160 (length of 0 for both).
18161
18162 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
18163
18164 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
18165 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018167res.ver : string
18168resp_ver : string (deprecated)
18169 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018170 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. It may be used in
18171 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018173 ACL derivatives :
18174 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018176set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18177 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18178 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018179 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018180 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018182 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
18183 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018184
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018185status : integer
18186 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
18187 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018188 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx. It may be used in
18189 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018190
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020018191unique-id : string
18192 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
18193 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
18194 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
18195 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
18196 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
18197 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
18198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018199url : string
18200 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
18201 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
18202 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
18203 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
18204 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
18205 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
18206 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018208 ACL derivatives :
18209 url : exact string match
18210 url_beg : prefix match
18211 url_dir : subdir match
18212 url_dom : domain match
18213 url_end : suffix match
18214 url_len : length match
18215 url_reg : regex match
18216 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018218url_ip : ip
18219 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
18220 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
18221 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
18222 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
18223 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
18224 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18225 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018227url_port : integer
18228 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
18229 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
18230 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18231 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018232
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018233urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
18234url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018235 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
18236 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018237 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
18238 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
18239 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
18240 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018241 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
18242 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018243 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
18244 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018246 ACL derivatives :
18247 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
18248 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
18249 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
18250 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
18251 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
18252 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
18253 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
18254 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018255
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018257 Example :
18258 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
18259 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
18260 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
18261 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018262
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018263urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018264 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
18265 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
18266 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020018267
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020018268url32 : integer
18269 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
18270 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
18271 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
18272 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
18273 is an unsigned integer.
18274
18275url32+src : binary
18276 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
18277 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
18278 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
18279
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020018280
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200182817.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018282---------------------------------------
18283
18284This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
18285used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
18286purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
18287There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
18288or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
18289any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
18290for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
18291
18292internal.htx.data : integer
18293 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
18294 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18295
18296internal.htx.free : integer
18297 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
18298 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18299
18300internal.htx.free_data : integer
18301 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
18302 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18303
18304internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
18305 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
18306 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
18307 chosen depending on the sample direction.
18308
18309internal.htx.nbblks : integer
18310 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
18311 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18312
18313internal.htx.size : integer
18314 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
18315 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18316
18317internal.htx.used : integer
18318 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
18319 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18320 direction.
18321
18322internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
18323 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18324 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
18325 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
18326 of the special value :
18327 * head : The oldest inserted block
18328 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018329 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018330
18331internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
18332 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18333 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
18334 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
18335 integer or one of the special value :
18336 * head : The oldest inserted block
18337 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018338 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018339
18340internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
18341 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18342 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
18343 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18344 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18345
18346 * head : The oldest inserted block
18347 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018348 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018349
18350internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
18351 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18352 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18353 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18354 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18355
18356 * head : The oldest inserted block
18357 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018358 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018359
18360internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
18361 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18362 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18363 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18364 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18365
18366 * head : The oldest inserted block
18367 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018368 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018369
18370internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
18371 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
18372 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
18373 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18374 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18375
18376 * head : The oldest inserted block
18377 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018378 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018379
18380internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
18381 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
18382 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
18383 it returns false.
18384
18385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200183867.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018387---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018388
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018389Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
18390every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020018391order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018392
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018393ACL name Equivalent to Usage
18394---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018395FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020018396HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018397HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
18398HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018399HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
18400HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
18401HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
18402HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
18403LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018404METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018405METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018406METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
18407METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
18408METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
18409METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018410METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018411METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018412RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018413REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018414TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018415WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
18416---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018417
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010018418
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184198. Logging
18420----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018421
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018422One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
18423provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
18424very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
18425provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
18426state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018427to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018428headers.
18429
18430In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
18431about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
18432send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
18433
18434 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
18435 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
18436 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
18437 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
18438 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018439 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060018440 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018441
18442The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
18443allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
18444as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
18445while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
18446real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
18447delay.
18448
18449
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184508.1. Log levels
18451---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018452
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018453TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018454source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018455HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
18456in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
18457track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
18458syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
18459about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018460
18461
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184628.2. Log formats
18463----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018464
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018465HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018466and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
18467slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
18468options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018469
18470 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
18471 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
18472 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
18473 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
18474 extents.
18475
18476 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
18477 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
18478 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
18479 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
18480 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
18481
18482 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
18483 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
18484 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
18485 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
18486 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
18487
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020018488 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
18489 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
18490 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
18491 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
18492
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018493 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
18494
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018495Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
18496specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
18497field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
18498servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
18499always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
18500identifier.
18501
18502Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
18503 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
18504 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
18505 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
18506 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
18507
18508
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185098.2.1. Default log format
18510-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018511
18512This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
18513as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
18514format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
18515
18516 Example :
18517 listen www
18518 mode http
18519 log global
18520 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18521
18522 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
18523 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
18524 (www/HTTP)
18525
18526 Field Format Extract from the example above
18527 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
18528 2 'Connect from' Connect from
18529 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
18530 4 'to' to
18531 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
18532 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
18533
18534Detailed fields description :
18535 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
18536 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
18537 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
18538 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
18539 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18540 and processed the connection.
18541 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
18542
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018543In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
18544"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
18545connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
18546
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018547It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
18548will eventually disappear.
18549
18550
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185518.2.2. TCP log format
18552---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018553
18554The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
18555is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
18556information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
18557counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
18558emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
18559environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
18560the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
18561sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018562specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
18563not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
18564fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
18565marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018566
18567 Example :
18568 frontend fnt
18569 mode tcp
18570 option tcplog
18571 log global
18572 default_backend bck
18573
18574 backend bck
18575 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18576
18577 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
18578 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
18579 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
18580
18581 Field Format Extract from the example above
18582 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
18583 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
18584 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
18585 4 frontend_name fnt
18586 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
18587 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
18588 7 bytes_read* 212
18589 8 termination_state --
18590 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
18591 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18592
18593Detailed fields description :
18594 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018595 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18596 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18597 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018598 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018599 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018600 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018601
18602 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018603 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18604 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18605 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018606
18607 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
18608 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
18609 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018610 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
18611 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
18612 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
18613 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018614
18615 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18616 and processed the connection.
18617
18618 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18619 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18620 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
18621 applications.
18622
18623 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18624 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18625 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18626 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
18627 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
18628
18629 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18630 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
18631 See "Timers" below for more details.
18632
18633 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18634 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
18635 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
18636 "Timers" below for more details.
18637
18638 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018639 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018640 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
18641 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
18642 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
18643 details.
18644
18645 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
18646 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
18647 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
18648 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
18649 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
18650
18651 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
18652 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
18653 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
18654 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
18655 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
18656 for more details.
18657
18658 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018659 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018660 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
18661 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
18662 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018663 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018664
18665 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
18666 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
18667 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
18668 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
18669 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
18670 caused by a denial of service attack.
18671
18672 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
18673 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
18674 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
18675 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
18676 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
18677 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
18678 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
18679 denial of service attack.
18680
18681 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
18682 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
18683 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
18684 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
18685 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
18686 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
18687 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
18688 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
18689 be processed than on other servers.
18690
18691 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
18692 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
18693 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
18694 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
18695 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
18696 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
18697 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
18698 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
18699 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
18700 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
18701 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
18702 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
18703 should not be attributed to the logged server.
18704
18705 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18706 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
18707 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
18708 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
18709 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
18710 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018711 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018712 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
18713
18714 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18715 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
18716 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
18717 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
18718 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
18719 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018720 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018721 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
18722 occurs.
18723
18724
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187258.2.3. HTTP log format
18726----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018727
18728The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
18729is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
18730the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
18731are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
18732emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
18733generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
18734"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
18735which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018736frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
18737is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018738
18739Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
18740slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
18741with a star ('*') after the field name below.
18742
18743 Example :
18744 frontend http-in
18745 mode http
18746 option httplog
18747 log global
18748 default_backend bck
18749
18750 backend static
18751 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18752
18753 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
18754 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
18755 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018756 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018757
18758 Field Format Extract from the example above
18759 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
18760 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018761 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018762 4 frontend_name http-in
18763 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018764 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018765 7 status_code 200
18766 8 bytes_read* 2750
18767 9 captured_request_cookie -
18768 10 captured_response_cookie -
18769 11 termination_state ----
18770 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
18771 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18772 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
18773 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
18774 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018775
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018776Detailed fields description :
18777 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018778 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18779 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18780 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018781 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018782 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018783 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018784
18785 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018786 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18787 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18788 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018789
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018790 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
18791 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018792
18793 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18794 and processed the connection.
18795
18796 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18797 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18798 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
18799
18800 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18801 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18802 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18803 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
18804 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
18805 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
18806
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018807 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
18808 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
18809 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018810 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018811 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
18812 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018813 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
18814 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018815
18816 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18817 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018818 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018819
18820 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18821 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018822 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
18823 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018824
18825 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
18826 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
18827 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
18828 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
18829 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018830 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
18831 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018832
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018833 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
18834 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
18835 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
18836 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
18837 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
18838 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
18839 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018840 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018841
18842 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
18843 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
18844 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
18845
18846 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
18847 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018848 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018849 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
18850 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
18851 overflowing.
18852
18853 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
18854 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
18855 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
18856 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
18857 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
18858 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
18859 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
18860 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
18861
18862 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
18863 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
18864 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
18865 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
18866 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
18867 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
18868 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
18869 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
18870
18871 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
18872 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
18873 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
18874 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
18875 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
18876 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
18877 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
18878
18879 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018880 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018881 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
18882 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
18883 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018884 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018885 system.
18886
18887 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
18888 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
18889 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
18890 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
18891 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
18892 caused by a denial of service attack.
18893
18894 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
18895 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
18896 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
18897 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
18898 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
18899 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
18900 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
18901 denial of service attack.
18902
18903 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
18904 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
18905 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
18906 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
18907 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
18908 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
18909 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
18910 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
18911 processed than on other servers.
18912
18913 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
18914 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
18915 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
18916 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
18917 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
18918 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
18919 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
18920 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
18921 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
18922 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
18923 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
18924 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
18925 should not be attributed to the logged server.
18926
18927 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18928 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
18929 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
18930 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
18931 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
18932 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018933 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018934 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
18935
18936 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18937 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
18938 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
18939 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
18940 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
18941 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018942 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018943 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
18944 occurs.
18945
18946 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
18947 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
18948 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
18949 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
18950 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
18951 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
18952 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
18953 cookies" below for more details.
18954
18955 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
18956 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
18957 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
18958 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
18959 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
18960 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
18961 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
18962 and cookies" below for more details.
18963
18964 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
18965 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
18966 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
18967 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
18968 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
18969 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
18970 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
18971 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
18972
18973
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200189748.2.4. Custom log format
18975------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018976
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018977The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018978mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018979
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018980HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018981Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
18982separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
18983prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
18984
18985Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
18986variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018987("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018988
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010018989If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020018990as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010018991less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
18992the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
18993
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020018994Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
18995"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
18996delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
18997preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018998
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018999Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
19000'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
19001https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
19002such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
19003
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019004Flags are :
19005 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019006 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019007 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
19008 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019009
19010 Example:
19011
19012 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
19013 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
19014
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019015 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
19016
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019017At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
19018
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019019 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
19020 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019021
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019022the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019023
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019024 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
19025 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
19026 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019027
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019028and the default TCP format is defined this way :
19029
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019030 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
19031 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019032
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019033Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
19034
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019035 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019036 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019037 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
19038 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
19039 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019040 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
19041 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
19042 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019043 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019044 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
19045 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000019046 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019047 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
19048 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010019049 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020019050 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019051 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019052 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019053 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020019054 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080019055 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019056 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
19057 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
19058 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
19059 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
19060 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019061 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019062 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019063 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019064 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019065 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019066 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
19067 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019068 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19069 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
19070 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019071 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019072 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
19073 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019074 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019075 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19076 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
19077 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020019078 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020019079 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019080 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
19081 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
19082 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
19083 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020019084 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019085 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019086 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019087 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010019088 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019089 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019090 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
19091 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
19092 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019093 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019094 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
19095 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019096 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019097 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
19098 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020019099 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019100 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019101 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019102 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019103
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019104 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019105
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019106
191078.2.5. Error log format
19108-----------------------
19109
19110When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
19111protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
19112By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
19113"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019114will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019115logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
19116
19117The format looks like this :
19118
19119 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
19120 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
19121 Connection error during SSL handshake
19122
19123 Field Format Extract from the example above
19124 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
19125 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
19126 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
19127 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
19128 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
19129
19130These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
19131failures.
19132
19133
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191348.3. Advanced logging options
19135-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019136
19137Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
19138just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
19139options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
19140for more information about their usage.
19141
19142
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191438.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
19144------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019145
19146It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
19147haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
19148commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
19149monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
19150ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
19151
19152 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
19153 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
19154 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
19155 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
19156
19157 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
19158 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
19159 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019160 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019161 such as other load-balancers.
19162
19163 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
19164 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
19165 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
19166
19167
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191688.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
19169----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019170
19171The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
19172what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
19173or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019174"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019175just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
19176log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
19177after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
19178is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
19179with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
19180with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
19181
19182
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191838.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
19184------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019185
19186Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
19187for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
19188"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
19189retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
19190raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
19191a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
19192file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
19193you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
19194"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
19195
19196
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191978.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
19198--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019199
19200Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
19201multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
19202them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
19203"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
19204logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
19205error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
19206and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
19207too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
19208useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
19209alternative.
19210
19211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200192128.4. Timing events
19213------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019214
19215Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
19216reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
19217the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
19218frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019219mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
19220addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
19221
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019222Timings events in HTTP mode:
19223
19224 first request 2nd request
19225 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
19226 t tr t tr ...
19227 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
19228 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
19229 :<---- Tq ---->: :
19230 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019231 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019232 :<--------- Ta --------->:
19233
19234Timings events in TCP mode:
19235
19236 TCP session
19237 |<----------------->|
19238 t t
19239 ---|----|----|----|----|---
19240 | Th Tw Tc Td |
19241 |<------ Tt ------->|
19242
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019243 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019244 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019245 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
19246 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
19247 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019248 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019249 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
19250 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
19251 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
19252 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019253
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019254 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
19255 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
19256 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019257 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
19258 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
19259 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
19260 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
19261 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
19262 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019263
19264 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
19265 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
19266 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
19267 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
19268 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
19269 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
19270 request typed by hand during a test.
19271
19272 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
19273 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019274 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019275 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
19276 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
19277 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
19278 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019279
19280 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
19281 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
19282 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
19283 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
19284 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
19285
19286 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
19287 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
19288 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
19289 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
19290 connection never established.
19291
19292 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
19293 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
19294 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
19295 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
19296 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
19297 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
19298 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
19299 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
19300 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
19301 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
19302 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
19303
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019304 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
19305 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
19306 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
19307 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
19308 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
19309 by subtracting other timers when valid :
19310
19311 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
19312
19313 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
19314 "Ta" can never be negative.
19315
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019316 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
19317 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019318 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
19319 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019320 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019321
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019322 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019323
19324 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019325 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
19326 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019327
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019328 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
19329 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
19330 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
19331 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
19332 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
19333 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
19334 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
19335 prefixed with a '+' sign.
19336
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019337These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
19338protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
19339that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019340due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
19341"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
19342that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019343
19344Most common cases :
19345
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019346 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
19347 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
19348 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
19349 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
19350 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
19351 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
19352 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
19353 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
19354 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
19355 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
19356 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020019357 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019358
19359 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
19360 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
19361 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
19362 of ms on remote networks.
19363
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019364 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
19365 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
19366 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019367
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019368 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
19369 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
19370 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
19371 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
19372 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
19373 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
19374 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
19375 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
19376 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019377
19378Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
19379
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019380 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019381 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019382 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019383
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019384 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019385 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
19386 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
19387
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019388 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019389 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
19390 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
19391 flags.
19392
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019393 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
19394 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019395 Check the session termination flags, then check the
19396 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
19397 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
19398 the client connection was maintained open.
19399
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019400 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019401 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019402 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019403 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
19404
19405
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200194068.5. Session state at disconnection
19407-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019408
19409TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
19410"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
194112-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
19412each of which has a special meaning :
19413
19414 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
19415 session to terminate :
19416
19417 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
19418
19419 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
19420 server explicitly refused it.
19421
19422 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
19423 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
19424 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
19425 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019426 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019427
19428 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
19429 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019430
19431 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
19432 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
19433 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
19434 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
19435 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
19436
19437 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
19438 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
19439 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
19440 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
19441 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
19442
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090019443 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
19444 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
19445
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070019446 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
19447 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
19448 backup connections when going up.
19449
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020019450 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
19451
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019452 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
19453 send or receive data.
19454
19455 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
19456 send or receive data.
19457
19458 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
19459 with nothing left in the buffers.
19460
19461 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
19462
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010019463 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019464 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
19465
19466 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
19467 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
19468 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
19469 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
19470 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
19471
19472 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
19473 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
19474
19475 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
19476 server (HTTP only).
19477
19478 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
19479
19480 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
19481 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
19482 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
19483
19484 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
19485 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
19486 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
19487
19488 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
19489
19490 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
19491 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
19492
19493 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
19494 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
19495 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
19496
19497 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
19498 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020019499 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
19500 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019501
19502 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
19503 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
19504 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
19505 another server.
19506
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019507 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019508 server.
19509
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019510 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
19511 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
19512 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
19513 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19514
19515 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
19516 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
19517 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
19518 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19519
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020019520 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
19521 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
19522 "use-server" rule).
19523
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019524 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19525
19526 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
19527 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
19528
19529 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
19530
19531 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
19532 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
19533 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
19534
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019535 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
19536 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019537 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019538 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
19539 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
19540
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019541 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
19542
19543 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
19544 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
19545
19546 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
19547
19548 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19549
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019550The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
19551was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019552helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
19553starvation, attacks, etc...
19554
19555The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
19556alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
19557easier finding and understanding.
19558
19559 Flags Reason
19560
19561 -- Normal termination.
19562
19563 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
19564 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
19565 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
19566 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
19567
19568 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
19569 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
19570 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
19571 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
19572 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
19573 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019574
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019575 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19576 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020019577 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019578
19579 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
19580 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
19581 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
19582
19583 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
19584 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
19585 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
19586 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
19587 the server takes too long to respond.
19588
19589 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
19590 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
19591 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
19592 long a time to respond.
19593
19594 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
19595 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
19596 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
19597 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019598 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
19599 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019600
19601 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
19602 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
19603 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
19604 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
19605 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020019606 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019607 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
19608 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
19609 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
19610 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
19611 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
19612 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
19613 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
19614 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019615 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019616 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
19617 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
19618 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019619
19620 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
19621 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019622 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
19623 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
19624 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
19625 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019626
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019627 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
19628 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
19629
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019630 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019631 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
19632 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019633 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019634 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
19635 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
19636
19637 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
19638 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
19639 503 or 504 here.
19640
19641 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
19642 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
19643 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
19644 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
19645 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
19646
19647 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19648 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019649 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019650 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
19651 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
19652
19653 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
19654 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
19655 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
19656 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
19657 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
19658 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
19659 between haproxy and the server.
19660
19661 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
19662 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
19663 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
19664 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
19665 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
19666 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
19667 solution is to fix the application.
19668
19669 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
19670 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
19671 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
19672 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
19673 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
19674 external attacks.
19675
19676 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
19677 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020019678 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019679 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
19680 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
19681
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019682 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
19683 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
19684 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019685 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020019686 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019687
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019688 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
19689 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
19690 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
19691 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019692 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
19693 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
19694 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
19695 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
19696 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019697
19698 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
19699 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
19700 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
19701 returned an HTTP 403 error.
19702
19703 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
19704 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
19705 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
19706 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
19707
19708 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
19709 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
19710 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
19711 only be solved by proper system tuning.
19712
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019713The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
19714persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
19715important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
19716re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
19717
19718 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
19719
19720 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
19721 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
19722 set on a GET request.
19723
19724 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
19725 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019726 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019727 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
19728
19729 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
19730 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
19731 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
19732
19733 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
19734 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
19735 already got a cookie.
19736
19737 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
19738 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
19739 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
19740 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
19741 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
19742
19743 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
19744 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
19745 new cookie was inserted in the response.
19746
19747 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
19748 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
19749 new cookie was inserted in the response.
19750
19751 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
19752 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
19753
19754 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
19755 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
19756 then advertised in the response.
19757
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019758
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197598.6. Non-printable characters
19760-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019761
19762In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
19763consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
19764converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
19765prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
19766being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
19767escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
19768is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
19769'}' when logging headers.
19770
19771Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
19772issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
19773containing spaces is "User-Agent".
19774
19775Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
19776the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
19777performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
19778
19779
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197808.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
19781---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019782
19783Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
19784achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019785section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019786cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
19787the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
19788the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019789locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019790not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
19791user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
19792a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
19793wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
19794
19795 Examples :
19796 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
19797 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
19798
19799 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
19800 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
19801
19802
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
19804---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019805
19806Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
19807proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
19808the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
19809server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
19810
19811Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
19812response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019813section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019814
19815It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019816time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
19817appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019818are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
19819and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
19820follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
19821request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
19822in the logs.
19823
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019824As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
19825frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
19826an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
19827
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019828 Example :
19829 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
19830 listen proxy-out
19831 mode http
19832 option httplog
19833 option logasap
19834 log global
19835 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
19836
19837 # log the name of the virtual server
19838 capture request header Host len 20
19839
19840 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
19841 capture request header Content-Length len 10
19842
19843 # log the beginning of the referrer
19844 capture request header Referer len 20
19845
19846 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
19847 capture response header Server len 20
19848
19849 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
19850 capture response header Content-Length len 10
19851
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019852 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019853 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
19854
19855 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
19856 capture response header Via len 20
19857
19858 # log the URL location during a redirection
19859 capture response header Location len 20
19860
19861 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
19862 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
19863 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19864 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
19865 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
19866
19867 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
19868 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
19869 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19870 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019871 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019872
19873 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
19874 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
19875 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19876 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
19877 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019878 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019879
19880
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198818.9. Examples of logs
19882---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019883
19884These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
19885them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
19886reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
19887
19888 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
19889 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
19890 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
19891
19892 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
19893 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
19894
19895 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
19896 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
19897 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
19898
19899 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
19900 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
19901
19902 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
19903 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
19904 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
19905
19906 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019907 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019908 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
19909 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
19910
19911 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
19912 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
19913 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
19914
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020019915 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
19916 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
19917 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
19918 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
19919 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
19920 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019921
19922 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019923 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019924
19925 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
19926 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
19927 Nothing was sent to any server.
19928
19929 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
19930 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
19931
19932 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
19933 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019934 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019935 send a 408 return code to the client.
19936
19937 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
19938 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
19939
19940 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
19941 5 seconds ("c----").
19942
19943 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
19944 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019945 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019946
19947 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019948 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019949 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
19950 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
19951 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
19952 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
19953 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010019954
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020019955
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200199569. Supported filters
19957--------------------
19958
19959Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
19960accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
19961unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
19962
19963See also : "filter"
19964
199659.1. Trace
19966----------
19967
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010019968filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019969
19970 Arguments:
19971 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
19972 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
19973
19974 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
19975 the client and the server. By default, this filter
19976 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
19977 only parses a random amount of the available data.
19978
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019979 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019980 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
19981 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
19982 amount of the parsed data.
19983
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019984 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010019985
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019986This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
19987callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
19988information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
19989filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
19990
19991Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
19992tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
19993a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
19994
19995
199969.2. HTTP compression
19997---------------------
19998
19999filter compression
20000
20001The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
20002keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020003when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
20004fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
20005done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
20006explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
20007filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
20008listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20009order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020010
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020011See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
20012 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020013
20014
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200200159.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
20016--------------------------------------------
20017
20018filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
20019
20020 Arguments :
20021
20022 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
20023 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
20024 parsed.
20025
20026 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
20027 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
20028 part must be placed in its own scope.
20029
20030The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
20031external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020032streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020033exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
20034also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
20035
20036SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
20037the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
20038
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010020039For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020040"doc/SPOE.txt".
20041
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100200429.4. Cache
20043----------
20044
20045filter cache <name>
20046
20047 Arguments :
20048
20049 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
20050
20051The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
20052"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020053cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020054other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
20055case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
20056is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
20057filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010020058listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20059order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010020060
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020061See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
20062 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
20063
20064
200659.5. Fcgi-app
20066-------------
20067
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020068filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020069
20070 Arguments :
20071
20072 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
20073
20074The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
20075request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
20076reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
20077used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
20078implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
20079used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
20080fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
20081used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20082order.
20083
20084See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
20085 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
20086
20087
2008810. FastCGI applications
20089-------------------------
20090
20091HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
20092feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
20093the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
20094FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
20095servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
20096FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
20097backend.
20098
20099HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
20100application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
20101connection.
20102
2010310.1. Setup
20104-----------
20105
2010610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
20107--------------------------
20108
20109fcgi-app <name>
20110 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
20111 document root must be defined.
20112
20113acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
20114 Declare or complete an access list.
20115
20116 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
20117 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
20118 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
20119 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
20120 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
20121
20122docroot <path>
20123 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
20124 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
20125 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
20126
20127index <script-name>
20128 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
20129 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
20130 is an optional setting.
20131
20132 Example :
20133 index index.php
20134
20135log-stderr global
20136log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
20137 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
20138 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
20139
20140 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
20141 default STDERR messages are ignored.
20142
20143pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20144 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
20145 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
20146 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20147
20148 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
20149 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
20150 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
20151 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
20152
20153 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
20154 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
20155
20156path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020157 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020158 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
20159 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
20160 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
20161 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
20162 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
20163 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
20164 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020165
20166 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020167 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020168 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
20169 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
20170 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
20171 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020172
20173 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020174 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
20175 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020176
20177option get-values
20178no option get-values
20179 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
20180
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020181 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020182 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
20183
20184 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
20185 application will accept.
20186
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020020187 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
20188 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020189
20190 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050020191 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020192 option is disabled.
20193
20194 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
20195 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
20196 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
20197 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
20198 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
20199 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
20200
20201option keep-conn
20202no option keep-conn
20203 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
20204 sending a response.
20205
20206 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
20207 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
20208
20209option max-reqs <reqs>
20210 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
20211 accept.
20212
20213 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
20214 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
20215 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
20216 to 1.
20217
20218option mpxs-conns
20219no option mpxs-conns
20220 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
20221
20222 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
20223 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
20224
20225set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20226 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
20227 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
20228 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
20229 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20230
20231 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
20232 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
20233 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
20234
20235 Example :
20236 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
20237 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
20238
20239 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
20240
20241
2024210.1.2. Proxy section
20243---------------------
20244
20245use-fcgi-app <name>
20246 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
20247
20248 Arguments :
20249 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
20250
20251 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
20252 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
20253 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
20254 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
20255 application may be defined at a time per backend.
20256
20257 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
20258 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
20259 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
20260 application are evaluated.
20261
20262
2026310.1.3. Example
20264---------------
20265
20266 frontend front-http
20267 mode http
20268 bind *:80
20269 bind *:
20270
20271 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
20272 default_backend back-static
20273
20274 backend back-static
20275 mode http
20276 server www A.B.C.D:80
20277
20278 backend back-dynamic
20279 mode http
20280 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
20281 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
20282
20283 fcgi-app php-fpm
20284 log-stderr global
20285 option keep-conn
20286
20287 docroot /var/www/my-app
20288 index index.php
20289 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
20290
20291
2029210.2. Default parameters
20293------------------------
20294
20295A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
20296the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020297script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020298applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
20299
20300 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20301 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
20302 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
20303 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
20304 | | |
20305 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20306 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
20307 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
20308 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
20309 | | application. |
20310 | | |
20311 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20312 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
20313 | | the request. It may not be set. |
20314 | | |
20315 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20316 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
20317 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
20318 | | the application's configuration. |
20319 | | |
20320 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20321 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
20322 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
20323 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
20324 | | |
20325 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20326 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
20327 | | following the part that identifies the script |
20328 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
20329 | | be defined. |
20330 | | |
20331 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20332 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
20333 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
20334 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
20335 | | is not set too. |
20336 | | |
20337 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20338 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
20339 | | set. |
20340 | | |
20341 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20342 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
20343 | | the request. |
20344 | | |
20345 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20346 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
20347 | | client as part of user authentication. |
20348 | | |
20349 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20350 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
20351 | | script to process the request. |
20352 | | |
20353 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20354 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
20355 | | |
20356 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20357 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
20358 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
20359 | | |
20360 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20361 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
20362 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
20363 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
20364 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
20365 | | |
20366 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20367 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
20368 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
20369 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
20370 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
20371 | | side. |
20372 | | |
20373 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20374 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
20375 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
20376 | | connected to. |
20377 | | |
20378 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20379 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
20380 | | |
20381 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20382 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
20383 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
20384 | | |
20385 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20386
20387
2038810.3. Limitations
20389------------------
20390
20391The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
20392way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
20393during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
20394establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
20395application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
20396or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
20397message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
20398these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
20399and HTTP servers under the same backend.
20400
20401Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
20402request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
20403requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
20404
20405About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
20406into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
20407fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
20408"http-request" ones.
20409
20410Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
20411FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
20412processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
20413must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
20414here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010020415
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020416/*
20417 * Local variables:
20418 * fill-column: 79
20419 * End:
20420 */